blob: 55a8fa728036397b0629491160e4593522ef5da3 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau9dc6b972019-06-16 21:49:47 +02005 version 2.1
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau84681322019-11-15 18:49:37 +01007 2019/11/15
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200856. Cache
866.1. Limitation
876.2. Setup
886.2.1. Cache section
896.2.2. Proxy section
90
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001169.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200117
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011810. FastCGI applications
11910.1. Setup
12010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12110.1.2. Proxy section
12210.1.3. Example
12310.2. Default parameters
12410.3. Limitations
125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126
1271. Quick reminder about HTTP
128----------------------------
129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
132on almost anything found in the contents.
133
134However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
135formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
136correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
137
138
1391.1. The HTTP transaction model
140-------------------------------
141
142The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100143to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
145connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146will involve a new connection :
147
148 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
149
150In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
151establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
152by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
153length.
154
155Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
156to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
157however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
158response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
159header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
160
161 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
162
163Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
164power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
165but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200166a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100168Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
170second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
171page :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
176latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
177correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
178the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100179server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
182time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
183are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
184parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
185carry the stream identifier.
186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
188connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
189leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
191processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
192waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200194HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100195 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
196 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100197 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100201For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
202the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100203server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
204is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
205servers.
206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
275received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
276processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
277as well as in server logs.
278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
295as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200598 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100599 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200600 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200601 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200603 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100606 - presetenv
607 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - uid
609 - ulimit-n
610 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200611 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200613 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200615 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - ssl-default-bind-options
617 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200618 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200619 - ssl-default-server-options
620 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100621 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100622 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100623 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100624 - 51degrees-data-file
625 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200626 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200627 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200628 - wurfl-data-file
629 - wurfl-information-list
630 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200631 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100632 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100635 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200636 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200638 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100639 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100640 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100641 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200642 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200643 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200644 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200645 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 - noepoll
647 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000648 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100650 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300651 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000652 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100653 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200654 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200655 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200656 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000657 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000658 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200659 - tune.buffers.limit
660 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200661 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200662 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100663 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200664 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200665 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200666 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100667 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200668 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200669 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100670 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100671 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100672 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100673 - tune.lua.session-timeout
674 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200675 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100676 - tune.maxaccept
677 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200678 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200679 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200680 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100681 - tune.rcvbuf.client
682 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100683 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200684 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100685 - tune.sndbuf.client
686 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100687 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100688 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200689 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100690 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200691 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200692 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100693 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200694 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100695 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200696 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
697 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
698 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100699 - tune.zlib.memlevel
700 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100701
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702 * Debugging
703 - debug
704 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705
706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007073.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708------------------------------------
709
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200710ca-base <dir>
711 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200712 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
713 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200714
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715chroot <jail dir>
716 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
717 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
718 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
719 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
720 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100721 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100722
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100723cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
724 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
725 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
726 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
727 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
728 set. These sets have the format
729
730 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
731
732 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100733 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100734 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
735 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100736 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
737 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100738 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100739 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100741 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
743 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
744 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
745 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100746
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100747 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
748 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
749 on the machine's word size.
750
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100751 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100752 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
753 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
754 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
755 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
756 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
757 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758
759 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
761
762 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
763 # first 4 CPUs
764
765 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
766 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
767 # word size.
768
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100770 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
772 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
773 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
774
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100775 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
776 # and so on.
777 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
778 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
779 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
780
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100782 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
783 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
784 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
785
786 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
788 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
789
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100790 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
791 # and a thread range.
792 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
793 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
794 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
795
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200796crt-base <dir>
797 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
798 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
799 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801daemon
802 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
803 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100804 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
805 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200806
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200807deviceatlas-json-file <path>
808 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100809 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200810
811deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100812 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200813 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
814
815deviceatlas-separator <char>
816 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
817 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
818
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100819deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200820 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
821 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
822 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100823
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900824external-check
825 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
826 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
827 See "option external-check".
828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200829gid <number>
830 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
831 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
832 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100833 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
834 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200835 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100836
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100837hard-stop-after <time>
838 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
839
840 Arguments :
841 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
842 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
843 SIGUSR1 signal.
844
845 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
846 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
847 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
848
849 Example:
850 global
851 hard-stop-after 30s
852
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200853h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
854 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
855 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
856 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
857 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
858 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
859 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
860 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
861 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
862 specified in a proxy.
863
864 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
865 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
866 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
867 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
868 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
869 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
870 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
871
872 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
873 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
874 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
875 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
876 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
877
878 Example:
879 global
880 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
881
882 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
883 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
884
885h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
886 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
887 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
888 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
889 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
890 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
891 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
892 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
893 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
894
895 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
896 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
897 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
898
899 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
900 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
901
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200902group <group name>
903 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
904 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100905
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200906log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
907 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100908 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100909 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100910 configured with "log global".
911
912 <address> can be one of:
913
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100914 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100915 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
916 port).
917
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100918 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
919 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
920 port).
921
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100922 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100923 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
924 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100925 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100926
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100927 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
928 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
929 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
930 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
931 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
932 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
933 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
934 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
935 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
936 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
937 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
938 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
939 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
940 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100941 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
942 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100943
944 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
945 "fd@2", see above.
946
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200947 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
948 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
949 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
950 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
951 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
952
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200953 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
954 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100955
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200956 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
957 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
958 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
959 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
960 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
961 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
962 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
963 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
964 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
965 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100966 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
967 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200968
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200969 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
970 one of the following :
971
972 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
973 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
974
975 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
976 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
977
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100978 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
979 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
980 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
981 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
982 logger consumes.
983
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100984 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
985 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
986 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
987 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
988
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200989 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
990 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
991 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
992 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
993 set with <sample_size> parameter.
994
995 <sample_size>
996 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
997 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
998 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
999 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1000 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1001
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001004 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1005 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1006 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1007
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001008 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1009 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1010 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1011 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001012
1013 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001014 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1015 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1016 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1017 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1018 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1019 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001021 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001022
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001023log-send-hostname [<string>]
1024 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1025 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1026 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1027 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1028 the logs.
1029
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001030log-tag <string>
1031 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1032 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1033 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001034 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001035
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001036lua-load <file>
1037 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1038 used multiple times.
1039
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001040master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001041 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1042 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1043 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001045 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1046 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001047 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1048 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1049 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1050 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1051 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001052
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001053 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001054
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001055mworker-max-reloads <number>
1056 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001057 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001058 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1059 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1060 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1061
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001062nbproc <number>
1063 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1064 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1065 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001066 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1067 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001068 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1069 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001071nbthread <number>
1072 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001073 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1074 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1075 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1076 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1077 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001078 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1079 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1080 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1081 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1082 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1083 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1084 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001085
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001087 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1089 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1090
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001091presetenv <name> <value>
1092 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1093 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1094 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1095 and "unsetenv".
1096
1097resetenv [<name> ...]
1098 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1099 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1100 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1101 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1102 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1103 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1104 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1105 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1106
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001107stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001108 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1109 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1110 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1111 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1112 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1113 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001114 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001115 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1116 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1117 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1118 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001119
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001120server-state-base <directory>
1121 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001122 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1123 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001124
1125server-state-file <file>
1126 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1127 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1128 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1129 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1130 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1131 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1132 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1133 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001134 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1135 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001136
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001137setenv <name> <value>
1138 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1139 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1140 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1141 and "unsetenv".
1142
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001143set-dumpable
1144 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001145 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1146 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1147 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1148 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1149 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1150 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1151 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1152 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1153 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1154 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1155 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1156 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1157 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1158 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1159 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1160 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1161 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001162
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001163ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1165 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001166 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001167 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001168 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1169 information and recommendations see e.g.
1170 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1171 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1172 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1173 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001174
1175ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1176 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1177 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1178 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1179 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1180 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001181 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1182 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1183 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001184 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001185
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001186ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1188 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1189 keyword to see available options.
1190
1191 Example:
1192 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001193 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001194
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001195ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1197 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001198 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001199 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001200 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1201 information and recommendations see e.g.
1202 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1203 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1204 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1205 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1206 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001207
1208ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1210 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1211 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1212 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1213 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001214 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1215 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1216 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1217 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001218
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001219ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1221 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1222 keyword to see available options.
1223
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001224ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1225 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1226 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1227 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001228 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001229 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001230 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1231 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1232 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1233 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001234 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1235 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1236 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1237
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001238ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1239 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1240 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1241 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1242
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001243stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1244 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1245 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1246 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001247 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001248 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001249
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001250 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1251 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1252 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001253
1254stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1255 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1256 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001257 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001258
1259stats maxconn <connections>
1260 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1261 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1262
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001263uid <number>
1264 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1265 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1266 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1267 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1268
1269ulimit-n <number>
1270 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1271 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1272 option.
1273
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001274unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1275 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1276
1277 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1278 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1279 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1280 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1281 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1282 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1283 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1284 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1285 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1286 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1287
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001288unsetenv [<name> ...]
1289 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1290 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1291 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1292 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1293 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1294 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1295 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1296
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001297user <user name>
1298 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1299 See also "uid" and "group".
1300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001301node <name>
1302 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1303
1304 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1305 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1306 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1307 traffic.
1308
1309description <text>
1310 Add a text that describes the instance.
1311
1312 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1313 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1314 "<" and ">" characters.
1315
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100131651degrees-data-file <file path>
1317 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001318 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001319
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001320 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001321 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1322
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000132351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001324 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1325 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1326 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1327
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001328 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001329 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1330
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200133151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001332 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1333 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1334
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001335 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1336 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1337
133851degrees-cache-size <number>
1339 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1340 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1341 By default, this cache is disabled.
1342
1343 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001344 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1345
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001346wurfl-data-file <file path>
1347 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1348 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1349
1350 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1351 with USE_WURFL=1.
1352
1353wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1354 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1355 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1356 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1357
1358 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1359
1360 Valid WURFL properties are:
1361 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1362
1363 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1364 device.
1365
1366 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1367 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1368
1369 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1370 particular web request.
1371
1372 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1373 used Libwurfl API version.
1374
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001375 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1376 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1377
1378 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1379 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1380
1381 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1382
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001383 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1384 with USE_WURFL=1.
1385
1386wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1387 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1388 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1389
1390 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1391 with USE_WURFL=1.
1392
1393wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1394 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1395 thus before the chroot.
1396
1397 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1398 with USE_WURFL=1.
1399
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001400wurfl-cache-size <size>
1401 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1402 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001403 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001404 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001405
1406 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1407 with USE_WURFL=1.
1408
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001409strict-limits
1410 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1411 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1412 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1413 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1414 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1415 keyword.
1416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014173.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001418-----------------------
1419
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001420busy-polling
1421 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1422 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1423 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1424 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1425 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1426 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1427 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1428 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1429 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1430 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1431 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1432 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1433 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1434 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1435 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1436 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1437 "poll" pollers.
1438
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001439max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1440 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1441 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1442 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1443 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1444 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1445 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1446 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1447 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001449maxconn <number>
1450 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1451 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1452 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001453 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1454 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1455 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1456 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001457 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1458 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1459 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1460 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1461 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1462 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001463
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001464maxconnrate <number>
1465 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1466 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1467 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1468 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1469 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1470 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1471 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1472 fairness.
1473
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001474maxcomprate <number>
1475 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001476 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001477 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1478 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1479 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001480 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001481 default value.
1482
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001483maxcompcpuusage <number>
1484 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1485 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1486 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1487 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1488 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1489 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1490 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1491 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1492
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001493maxpipes <number>
1494 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1495 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1496 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1497 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1498 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1499 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1500
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001501maxsessrate <number>
1502 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1503 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1504 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1505 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1506 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1507 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1508 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1509 fairness.
1510
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001511maxsslconn <number>
1512 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1513 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1514 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1515 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1516 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1517 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1518 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001519 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1520 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1521 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1522 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1523 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1524 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1525 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001526
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001527maxsslrate <number>
1528 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1529 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1530 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1531 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1532 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1533 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1534 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1535 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1536 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1537 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1538
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001539maxzlibmem <number>
1540 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1541 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1542 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001543 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1544 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1545 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001547noepoll
1548 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1549 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001550 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001551
1552nokqueue
1553 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1554 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1555 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1556
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001557noevports
1558 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1559 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1560 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1561 also "nopoll".
1562
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001563nopoll
1564 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1565 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001566 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001567 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1568 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001570nosplice
1571 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001572 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001573 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001574 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001575 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1576 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1577 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1578 "option splice-response".
1579
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001580nogetaddrinfo
1581 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1582 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1583
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001584noreuseport
1585 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1586 command line argument "-dR".
1587
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001588profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1589 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1590 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1591 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1592 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001593 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001594 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1595 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1596 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1597 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1598
1599 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1600 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1601 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1602 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1603 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001604 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1605 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1606 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1607 CLI.
1608
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001609spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001610 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1611 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1612 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1613 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1614 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1615 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001616
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001617ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001618 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001619 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001620 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1621 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1622 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1623 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1624 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1626 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001627 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1628 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1629 openssl configuration file uses:
1630 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1631
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001632ssl-mode-async
1633 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001634 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001635 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1636 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1637 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001638 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001639 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001640
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001641tune.buffers.limit <number>
1642 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1643 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1644 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1645 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1646 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001647 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001648 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1649 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1650 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1651 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1652 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1653 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1654 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1655 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1656 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1657
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001658tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1659 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1660 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1661 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1662 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1663
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001664tune.bufsize <number>
1665 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1666 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1667 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1668 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1669 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1670 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1671 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001672 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1673 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1674 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001675 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001676 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1677 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1678 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001679
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001680tune.chksize <number>
1681 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1682 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1683 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1684 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1685 checks whenever possible.
1686
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001687tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1688 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1689 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1690 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1691 this value. The default value is 1.
1692
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001693tune.fail-alloc
1694 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1695 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1696 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1697 gracefully.
1698
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001699tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1700 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1701 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1702 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1703 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1704 change it.
1705
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001706tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1707 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001708 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1709 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001710 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1711 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1712 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1713 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1714 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1715
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001716tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1717 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1718 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1719 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1720 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1721 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1722 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1723 recommended not to change this value.
1724
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001725tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1726 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1727 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1728 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1729 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1730 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1731 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1732 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1733
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001734tune.http.cookielen <number>
1735 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1736 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1737 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1738 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1739 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1740 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1741 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1742 to change this value.
1743
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001744tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001745 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1746 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001747 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001749 configuration directives too.
1750 The default value is 1024.
1751
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001752tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1753 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1754 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1755 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1756 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1757 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1758 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001759 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1760 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1761 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001762
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001763tune.idletimer <timeout>
1764 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1765 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1766 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1767 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1768 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1769 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001771 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001772 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1773
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001774tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1775 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1776 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1777 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1778 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1779 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1780 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1781 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1782 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1783 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1784
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001785tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1786 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001787 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001788 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1789 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001790 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001791 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1792 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1793
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001794tune.lua.maxmem
1795 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1796 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1797 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1798 memory.
1799
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001800tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1801 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001802 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1803 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001804 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001805
1806tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1807 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1808 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1809 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1810 check servers.
1811
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001812tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1813 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1814 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1815 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001816 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001817
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001818tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001819 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1820 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1821 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1822 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1823 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1824 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1825 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1826 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1827 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1828 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001829
1830tune.maxpollevents <number>
1831 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1832 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1833 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1834 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1835 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1836
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001837tune.maxrewrite <number>
1838 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1839 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1840 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1841 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1842 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1843 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1844 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1845 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1846 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1847 bufsize.
1848
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001849tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1850 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1851 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1852 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1853 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1854 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1855 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1856 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1857 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1858 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001859 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1860 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001861 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1862 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1863 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1864 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1865 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1866 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1867 setting this parameter to 0.
1868
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001869tune.pipesize <number>
1870 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1871 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1872 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1873 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1874 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1875 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1876
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001877tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1878 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1879 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1880 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1881 default is 20.
1882
1883tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1884 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1885 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1886 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1887 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1888 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1889 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001890 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001891
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001892tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1893tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1894 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1895 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1896 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001897 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001899 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1900 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1901
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001902tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001903 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001904 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1905 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1906 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1907 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1908
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001909tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001910 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001911 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1912 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1913
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001914tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1915tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1916 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1917 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1918 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001919 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001920 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001921 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1922 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1923 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1924 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1925 notifying haproxy again.
1926
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001927tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001928 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1929 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1930 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001931 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001932 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001933 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001934 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1935 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1936 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001937 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1938 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001939
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001940tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001941 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001942 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1943 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1944 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1945 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1946 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1947
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001948tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1949 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001950 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001951 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1952 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1953 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1954 being used for too long.
1955
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001956tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1957 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1958 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1959 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1960 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1961 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1962 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1963 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1964 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1965 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1966 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001967 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001968 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001969
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001970tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1971 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1972 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1973 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1974 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1975 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1976 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1977 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001978 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1979 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001980
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001981tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1982 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1983 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1984 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1985 1000 entries.
1986
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001987tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1988 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1989 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1990 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1991
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001992tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001993tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001994tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1995tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1996tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001997 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1998 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1999 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2000 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2001 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2002 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2003 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2004 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002005
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002006 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2007 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2008 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2009 all available space is consumed.
2010 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2011 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2012 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002013
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002014tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2015 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002016 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002017 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002018 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002019 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2020
2021tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2022 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2023 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002024 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2025 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020273.3. Debugging
2028--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002029
2030debug
2031 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2032 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2033 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2034 system startup.
2035
2036quiet
2037 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2038 line argument "-q".
2039
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020413.4. Userlists
2042--------------
2043It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2044http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2045it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2046
2047userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002048 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002049 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2050
2051group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002052 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2054 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2055
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002056user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2057 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2059 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002060 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2061 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2062 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2063 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002064
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002065 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2066 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2067 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2068 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2069 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2070 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2071 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2072 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2073 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002074
2075 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002076 userlist L1
2077 group G1 users tiger,scott
2078 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002079
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002080 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2081 user scott insecure-password elgato
2082 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002083
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002084 userlist L2
2085 group G1
2086 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002087
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002088 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2089 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2090 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002091
2092 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002093
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002094
20953.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002097It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2098several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2099instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2100values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2101automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2102In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2103using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2104tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2105reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2106Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2107that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2108each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002109
2110peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002111 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002112 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2113
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002114bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2115 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2116 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2117
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002118disabled
2119 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2120 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2121 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2122
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002123default-bind [param*]
2124 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2125
2126default-server [param*]
2127 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2128
2129 Arguments:
2130 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2131 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2132 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2133 details.
2134
2135
2136 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2137
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002138enable
2139 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2140
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002141log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2142 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2143 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2144 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2145 more details.
2146
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002147peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002148 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2149 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2150 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2151 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2152 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2153 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2154
2155 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2156 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2157
2158 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2159 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2160 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2161 across all peers.
2162
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002163 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2164 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002165
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002166 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2167 "server" keyword explanation below).
2168
2169server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002170 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002171 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2172 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2173 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2174 of this "peers" section).
2175 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2176
2177
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002178 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002179 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002180 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002181 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2182 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2183 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002184
2185 backend mybackend
2186 mode tcp
2187 balance roundrobin
2188 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2189 stick on src
2190
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002191 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2192 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002193
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002194 Example:
2195 peers mypeers
2196 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2197 default-server ssl verify none
2198 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2199 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002200
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002201
2202table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2203 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2204
2205 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2206 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002207 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002208 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2209 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2210 "stick-table" keyword).
2211
2212 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2213 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2214 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2215 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2216 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2217 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2218 of the stick-table name as follows:
2219
2220 peers mypeers
2221 peer A ...
2222 peer B ...
2223 table t1 ...
2224
2225 frontend fe1
2226 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2227
2228 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2229 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2230
2231 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2232 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2233 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2234 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2235 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2236 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2237 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2238
2239 peers mypeers
2240 peer A ...
2241 peer B ...
2242 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2243
2244 backend t1
2245 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2246
2247 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2248 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2249 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2250
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022513.6. Mailers
2252------------
2253It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2254If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2255in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2256
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002257mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002258 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2259 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2260
2261mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2262 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2263
2264 Example:
2265 mailers mymailers
2266 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2267 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2268
2269 backend mybackend
2270 mode tcp
2271 balance roundrobin
2272
2273 email-alert mailers mymailers
2274 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2275 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2276
2277 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2278 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2279
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002280timeout mail <time>
2281 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2282 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2283 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2284 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2285
2286 Example:
2287 mailers mymailers
2288 timeout mail 20s
2289 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002290
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022913.7. Programs
2292-------------
2293In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2294master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2295managed the same way as the workers.
2296
2297During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2298sequence as a worker:
2299
2300 - the master is re-executed
2301 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2302 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2303 instance of the program
2304
2305During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2306
2307program <name>
2308 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2309 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2310 the management guide).
2311
2312command <command> [arguments*]
2313 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2314 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2315 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2316 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2317
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002318user <user name>
2319 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2320 See also "group".
2321
2322group <group name>
2323 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2324 See also "user".
2325
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002326option start-on-reload
2327no option start-on-reload
2328 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2329 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2330 program section.
2331
2332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023334. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002334----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002336Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002337 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002338 - frontend <name>
2339 - backend <name>
2340 - listen <name>
2341
2342A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2343its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2344section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002346
2347A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2348connections.
2349
2350A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2351to forward incoming connections.
2352
2353A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2354parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002356All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2357'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2358case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2359
2360Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2361logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2362proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2363However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2364name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2365
2366Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2367and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002368bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2370modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2371arbitrary criteria.
2372
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002373In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2374a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002375the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002376
2377 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2378 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2379 between responses and new requests.
2380
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002381 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2382 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2383 client-facing connection remains open.
2384
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002385 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2386 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002387
2388The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2389frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2390following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002391weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002392
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002393 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002394
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002395 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2396 ----+-----+-----+----
2397 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2398 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002399 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2400 ----+-----+-----+----
2401 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002402
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024054.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2406--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002408The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2409limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2410they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2411limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002412marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002413option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002414and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2415with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2416specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002418
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2420------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2421acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002422backlog X X X -
2423balance X - X X
2424bind - X X -
2425bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002426capture cookie - X X -
2427capture request header - X X -
2428capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002429compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002430cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002431declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002432default-server X - X X
2433default_backend X X X -
2434description - X X X
2435disabled X X X X
2436dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002437email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002438email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002439email-alert mailers X X X X
2440email-alert myhostname X X X X
2441email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002442enabled X X X X
2443errorfile X X X X
2444errorloc X X X X
2445errorloc302 X X X X
2446-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2447errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002448force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002449filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002450fullconn X - X X
2451grace X X X X
2452hash-type X - X X
2453http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002454http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002455http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002456http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002457http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002458http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002459http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002460id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002461ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002462load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002463log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002464log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002465log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002466log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002467max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002468maxconn X X X -
2469mode X X X X
2470monitor fail - X X -
2471monitor-net X X X -
2472monitor-uri X X X -
2473option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2474option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2475option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2476option allbackups (*) X - X X
2477option checkcache (*) X - X X
2478option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2479option contstats (*) X X X -
2480option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2481option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002482-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2483option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002484option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2485option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002486option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002487option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002488option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002489option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002490option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2492option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2493option httpchk X - X X
2494option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002495option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002497option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002498option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002499option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2501option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2502option logasap (*) X X X -
2503option mysql-check X - X X
2504option nolinger (*) X X X X
2505option originalto X X X X
2506option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002507option pgsql-check X - X X
2508option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002509option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002510option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002511option smtpchk X - X X
2512option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2513option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2514option splice-request (*) X X X X
2515option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002516option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002517option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2518option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2519-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002520option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002521option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2522option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2523option tcpka X X X X
2524option tcplog X X X X
2525option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002526external-check command X - X X
2527external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002528persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2529rate-limit sessions X X X -
2530redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002531-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002532retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002533retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002534server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002535server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002536server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002537source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002538stats admin - X X X
2539stats auth X X X X
2540stats enable X X X X
2541stats hide-version X X X X
2542stats http-request - X X X
2543stats realm X X X X
2544stats refresh X X X X
2545stats scope X X X X
2546stats show-desc X X X X
2547stats show-legends X X X X
2548stats show-node X X X X
2549stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002550-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2551stick match - - X X
2552stick on - - X X
2553stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002554stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002555stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002556tcp-check connect - - X X
2557tcp-check expect - - X X
2558tcp-check send - - X X
2559tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002560tcp-request connection - X X -
2561tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002562tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002563tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002564tcp-response content - - X X
2565tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002566timeout check X - X X
2567timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002568timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002570timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2571timeout http-request X X X X
2572timeout queue X - X X
2573timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002574timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002575timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002576timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002577transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002578unique-id-format X X X -
2579unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002581use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002582use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2584 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025874.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2588---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002589
2590This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2591
2592
2593acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2594 Declare or complete an access list.
2595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2596 no | yes | yes | yes
2597 Example:
2598 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2599 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2600 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002602 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
2604
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002605backlog <conns>
2606 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2608 yes | yes | yes | no
2609 Arguments :
2610 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2611 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002612 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002613
2614 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2615 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2616 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2617 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2618 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2619 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2620 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2621 backlog parameter.
2622
2623 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2624 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2625 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2626
2627 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2628
2629
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002630balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002631balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2634 yes | no | yes | yes
2635 Arguments :
2636 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2637 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2638 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2639 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2640
2641 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2642 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2643 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2644 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002645 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002646 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002647 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2648 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2649 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2650 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2651 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2652 it, so that you don't worry.
2653
2654 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2655 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2656 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2657 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2658 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2659 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2660 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2661 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002662
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002663 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2664 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2665 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2666 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2667 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2668 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2669 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2670 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2671
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002672 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002673 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002674 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2675 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002676 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002677 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2678 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2679 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2680 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2681 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002682 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2683 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2684 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2685 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2686 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2687 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002689 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2690 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2691 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2692 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2693 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2694 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2695 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2696 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002697 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002698 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002699 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2700 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2701 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002703 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2704 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2705 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2706 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2707 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2708 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2709 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2710 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2711 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2712 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2713 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2714 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002716 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002717 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2718 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2719 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2720 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2721 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2722 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2723 URIs start with a leading "/".
2724
2725 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2726 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2727 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2728 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2729
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002731 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2732
2733 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002734 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2735 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002736 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2737 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2738 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2739 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002740 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002741 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2742 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002743
2744 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2745 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2746 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2747 server will receive the request.
2748
2749 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2750 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2751 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2752 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2753 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002754 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2755 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2756 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002757
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002758 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2759 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2760 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2761 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2762 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002764 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002765 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2766 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2767 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2768
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002769 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2770 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2771 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2772
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002773 random
2774 random(<draws>)
2775 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002776 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2777 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2778 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2779 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002780 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2781 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2782 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2783 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2784 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2785 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2786 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2787 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2788 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2789 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2790 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2791 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2792 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2793 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2794 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2795 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2796 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2797 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2798 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2799 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002800
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002801 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002802 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002803 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2804 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2805 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2806 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2807 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2808 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002809 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002810 used instead.
2811
2812 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2813 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2814 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2815 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2816
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002817 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2818 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2819 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2820
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002821 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002824 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2825 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002826
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002827 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2828 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2829 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002831 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002832 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002833 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2834 NTLM relies on.
2835
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002836 Examples :
2837 balance roundrobin
2838 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002839 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002840 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2841 balance hdr(host)
2842 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002843
2844 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2845 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002847 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002848 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2849 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2850 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002851 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002852
2853 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2854 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2855 defaults to 16 kB.
2856
2857 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2858 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2859
2860 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2861 Round Robin.
2862
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002863 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002864 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2865 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2866 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2867
2868 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2869
2870 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002871 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002872 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2873 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2874 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002876 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877
2878
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002879bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2880bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2883 no | yes | yes | no
2884 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002885 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2886 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2887 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2888 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002889 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002890 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2891 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2892 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2893 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2894 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2895 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2896 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002897 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2898 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2899 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2900 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2901 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2902 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2903 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002904 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2905 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2906 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002907 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2908 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2909 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2910 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002911 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2912 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2913 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002914
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002915 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2916 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002917 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2918 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2919 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002920 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2921 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2922 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2923 the range.
2924
2925 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2926 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2927 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2928 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2929 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2930 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2931 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002932 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002933 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002934
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002935 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002936 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002937 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2938 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2939 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2940 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2941 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2942 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2943
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002944 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2945 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2946 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2947 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002949 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2950 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2951 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2952 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2953 in a frontend.
2954
2955 Example :
2956 listen http_proxy
2957 bind :80,:443
2958 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002959 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002960
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002961 listen http_https_proxy
2962 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002963 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002964
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002965 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2966 bind ipv6@:80
2967 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2968 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2969
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002970 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002971 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002972
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002973 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2974 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2975 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2976 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2977 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2978
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002979 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002980 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002981
2982
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002983bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002984 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2986 yes | yes | yes | yes
2987 Arguments :
2988 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2989 may be used to override a default value.
2990
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002991 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002992 option may be combined with other numbers.
2993
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002994 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002995 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2996 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2997 missing from all processes.
2998
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002999 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003000 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003001 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3002 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3003 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3004 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3005 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003006 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003007
3008 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3009 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3010 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3011 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3012 and 'even' instances.
3013
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003014 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3015 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3016 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3017 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003018
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003019 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3020 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3021
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003022 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3023 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3024 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3025
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003026 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3027 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3028
3029 Example :
3030 listen app_ip1
3031 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003032 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003033
3034 listen app_ip2
3035 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003036 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003037
3038 listen management
3039 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003040 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003041
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003042 listen management
3043 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3044 bind-process 1-4
3045
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003046 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003047
3048
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049capture cookie <name> len <length>
3050 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3052 no | yes | yes | no
3053 Arguments :
3054 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3055 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3056 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3057 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003058 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003059
3060 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3061 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3062 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3063 right if it exceeds <length>.
3064
3065 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3066 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3067 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3068 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3069
3070 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3071 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3072 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3073
3074 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3075 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3076 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003077 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3078 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3079 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003080
3081 Example:
3082 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3083
3084 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003085 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086
3087
3088capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003089 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3091 no | yes | yes | no
3092 Arguments :
3093 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003094 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003095 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3096 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3097 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3098
3099 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3100 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3101 it exceeds <length>.
3102
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003103 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003104 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3105 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003106 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3107 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3108 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3109 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003110 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003111 environments to find where the request came from.
3112
3113 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3114 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3115 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3116 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003118 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3119 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3120 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3121 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3122 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123
3124 Example:
3125 capture request header Host len 15
3126 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003127 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003129 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130 about logging.
3131
3132
3133capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003134 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3136 no | yes | yes | no
3137 Arguments :
3138 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003139 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003140 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3141 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3142 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3143
3144 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3145 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3146 it exceeds <length>.
3147
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003148 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003149 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3150 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3151 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003152 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3153 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3154 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3155 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003157 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3158 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3159 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3160 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3161 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
3163 Example:
3164 capture response header Content-length len 9
3165 capture response header Location len 15
3166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003167 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168 about logging.
3169
3170
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003171compression algo <algorithm> ...
3172compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003173compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003174 Enable HTTP compression.
3175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 yes | yes | yes | yes
3177 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003178 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3179 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3180 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3181
3182 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003183 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3184 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3185 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003186
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003187 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003188 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003189
3190 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3191 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3192 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3193 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3194 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003195 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003196
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003197 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3198 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3199 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3200 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3201 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3202 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3203 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003204 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003205
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003206 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003207 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003208 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3209 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3210 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3211 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3212 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003213
3214 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3215 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3216 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3217 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3218 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003219 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3220 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3221 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3222 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3223 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003224 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3225 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003226
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003227 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003228 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3229 "Accept-Encoding" header
3230 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003231 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003232 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3233 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3234 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3235 "multipart"
3236 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3237 header
3238 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3239 and later
3240 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3241 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003242 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003243
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003244 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003245
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003246 Examples :
3247 compression algo gzip
3248 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003249
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003250
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003251cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003252 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3253 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003254 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003255 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 yes | no | yes | yes
3258 Arguments :
3259 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3260 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3261 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3262 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3263 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3264 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003265 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003266 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3267 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3268
3269 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3270 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3271 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3272 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3273 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3274 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003275 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3276 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003277 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003278 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3279 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003280
3281 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003282 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003283
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003284 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003285 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003286 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003287 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003288 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3289 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3290 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3291 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3292 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3293 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3294 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295
3296 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3297 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3298 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3299 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3300 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3301 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3302 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3303 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3304 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003305 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003306 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3307 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3308 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003309
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003310 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3311 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3312 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003313 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3314 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3315 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3316 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003317 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3318 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3319 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320
3321 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3322 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3323 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3324 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3325 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3326 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3327 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3328 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3329 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3330
3331 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3332 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3333 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3334 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3335 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3336 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3337 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3338 persistence cookie in the cache.
3339 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3340
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003341 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3342 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3343 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3344 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3345 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003346 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003347 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3348 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3349 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3350 they logout.
3351
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003352 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3353 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3354 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3355 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3356
3357 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3358 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3359 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3360 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3361 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3362 this attribute.
3363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003364 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003365 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003366 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3367 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3368 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3369 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3370 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3371 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003372
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003373 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3374 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3375 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3376 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3377 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3378 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3379 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3380 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003382 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3383 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3384 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3385 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3386 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3387 the site.
3388
3389 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3390 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3391 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3392 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3393 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3394 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3395 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3396 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3397 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3398 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3399 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3400 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3401 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003402 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003403 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3404 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3405
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003406 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3407 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3408 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3409 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3410 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3411 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3412
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003413 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3414 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3415 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3416 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003418 Examples :
3419 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3420 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3421 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003422 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003424 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003426
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003427declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3428 Declares a capture slot.
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 no | yes | yes | no
3431 Arguments:
3432 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3433
3434 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3435 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3436 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3437 for use in the response.
3438
3439 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003440 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003441 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3442
3443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003444default-server [param*]
3445 Change default options for a server in a backend
3446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3447 yes | no | yes | yes
3448 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003449 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3450 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3451 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3452 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003453
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003454 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003455 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3456
3457 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003458
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460default_backend <backend>
3461 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 yes | yes | yes | no
3464 Arguments :
3465 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3466
3467 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3468 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3469 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3470 will catch all undetermined requests.
3471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472 Example :
3473
3474 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3475 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3476 default_backend dynamic
3477
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003478 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003480
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003481description <string>
3482 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3484 no | yes | yes | yes
3485 Arguments : string
3486
3487 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3488 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3489 it describes.
3490 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3491
3492
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003493disabled
3494 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 yes | yes | yes | yes
3497 Arguments : none
3498
3499 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3500 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3501 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3502 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3503 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3504 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3505 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3506
3507 See also : "enabled"
3508
3509
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003510dispatch <address>:<port>
3511 Set a default server address
3512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3513 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003515
3516 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3517 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3518 during start-up.
3519
3520 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3521 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3522 possible with normal servers.
3523
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003524 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003525 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3526 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3527 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3528 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3529
3530 See also : "server"
3531
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003532
3533dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3534 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | no | yes | yes
3537 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3538
3539 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003540 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003541 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3542 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003543 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003544 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003545
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003546enabled
3547 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3549 yes | yes | yes | yes
3550 Arguments : none
3551
3552 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3553 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3554
3555 See also : "disabled"
3556
3557
3558errorfile <code> <file>
3559 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 yes | yes | yes | yes
3562 Arguments :
3563 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003564 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3565 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003566
3567 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003568 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003570 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3571 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003572
3573 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3574 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3575 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3576
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003577 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3580 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3581 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3582 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3583
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003584 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3585 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003586 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003587 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3588 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3589 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3592 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3593 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003594 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3596
3597 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3598
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003599 Example :
3600 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003601 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003602 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3603 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3604
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003605
3606errorloc <code> <url>
3607errorloc302 <code> <url>
3608 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3610 yes | yes | yes | yes
3611 Arguments :
3612 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003613 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3614 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615
3616 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3617 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3618 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3619 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003620 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003621
3622 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3623 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3624 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3625
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003626 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3627
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003628 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3629 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3630 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3631 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003632 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003633 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3634 request.
3635
3636 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3637
3638
3639errorloc303 <code> <url>
3640 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3642 yes | yes | yes | yes
3643 Arguments :
3644 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003645 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3646 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003647
3648 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3649 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3650 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3651 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003652 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003653
3654 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3655 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3656 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3657
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003658 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3659
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003660 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3661 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3662 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3663 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003664 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003665
3666 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3667
3668
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003669email-alert from <emailaddr>
3670 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003671 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 yes | yes | yes | yes
3674
3675 Arguments :
3676
3677 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3678
3679 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3680 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3681
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003682 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003683 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3684 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003685
3686
3687email-alert level <level>
3688 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3689 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 yes | yes | yes | yes
3692
3693 Arguments :
3694
3695 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3696 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3697 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3698
3699 By default level is alert
3700
3701 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3702 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3703 for the proxy.
3704
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003705 Alerts are sent when :
3706
3707 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3708 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3709 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3710 is notice or lower
3711 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3712 and a health check status update occurs
3713
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003714 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3715 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003716 section 3.6 about mailers.
3717
3718
3719email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3720 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | yes | yes | yes
3723
3724 Arguments :
3725
3726 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3727
3728 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3729 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3730
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003731 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3732 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003733
3734
3735email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3736 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3737 mailers.
3738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | yes
3740
3741 Arguments :
3742
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003743 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003744
3745 By default the systems hostname is used.
3746
3747 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3748 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3749 for the proxy.
3750
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003751 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3752 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003753
3754
3755email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003757 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | yes | yes | yes
3760
3761 Arguments :
3762
3763 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3764
3765 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3766 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3767
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003768 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003769 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3770
3771
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003772force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3773 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003775 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003776
3777 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3778 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3779 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3780 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3781 marked down for maintenance operations.
3782
3783 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3784 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3785 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3786 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3787 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3788 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3789 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3790 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3791 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3792
3793 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3794 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3795 is used.
3796
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003797 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003798 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003799
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003800
3801filter <name> [param*]
3802 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3804 no | yes | yes | yes
3805 Arguments :
3806 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3807 referenced in section 9.
3808
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003809 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003810 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003811 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3812 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003813
3814 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3815 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3816
3817 Example:
3818 listen
3819 bind *:80
3820
3821 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3822 filter compression
3823 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3824
3825 compression algo gzip
3826 compression offload
3827
3828 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3829
3830 See also : section 9.
3831
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833fullconn <conns>
3834 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3836 yes | no | yes | yes
3837 Arguments :
3838 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3839 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3840
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003841 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003842 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003843 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003844 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3845 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3846 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3847 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3848 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003849 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003850
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003851 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3852 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003853 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3854 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3855 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003856
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003857 Example :
3858 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3859 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3860 # connections.
3861 backend dynamic
3862 fullconn 10000
3863 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3864 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3865
3866 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3867
3868
3869grace <time>
3870 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003872 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003873 Arguments :
3874 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3875 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3876 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3877
3878 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3879 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003880 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003881 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3882
3883 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3884 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3885 simplify it.
3886
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003887
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003888hash-balance-factor <factor>
3889 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3891 yes | no | no | yes
3892 Arguments :
3893 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3894 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003895 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003896
3897 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3898 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3899 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3900 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3901 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3902 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3903 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3904
3905 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3906 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3907 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3908 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3909 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3910
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003911 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3912 consistent hashing mechanism.
3913
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003914 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3915
3916
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003917hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003918 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 yes | no | yes | yes
3921 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003922 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3923 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003924
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003925 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3926 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3927 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3928 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3929 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3930 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3931 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3932 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3933 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3934 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003935
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003936 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3937 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3938 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3939 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3940 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3941 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3942 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3943 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3944 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3945 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3946 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3947 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3948 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003949 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3950 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003951
3952 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3953
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003954 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003955 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3956 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3957 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003958 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3959 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3960 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003961
3962 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3963 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003964 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3965 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3966 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3967 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3968
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003969 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3970 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3971 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3972 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3973 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3974 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3975 parameter.
3976
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003977 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3978 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3979 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3980 used on strings.
3981
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003982 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3983
3984 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3985 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3986 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3987 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3988 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3989 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3990 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3991 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3992 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3993 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3994 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3995 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003996
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003997 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3998 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3999 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004000
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004001 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004002
4003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004http-check disable-on-404
4005 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004007 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004008 Arguments : none
4009
4010 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4011 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4012 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4013 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4014 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4015 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4016 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4017 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004018 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4019 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4020 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4021
4022 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4023
4024
4025http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004026 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004028 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004029 Arguments :
4030 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4031 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004032 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004033 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4034 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4035 details on the supported keywords.
4036
4037 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4038 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4039 with the usual backslash ('\').
4040
4041 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4042 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4043 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4044 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4045 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4046
4047 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004048 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004049 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4050 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4051 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4052
4053 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004054 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004055 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4056 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4057 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4058 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4059
4060 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004061 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004062 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4063 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4064 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4065 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4066 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004067 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004068 trace).
4069
4070 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004071 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004072 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4073 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4074 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4075 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4076 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004077 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004078
4079 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4080 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4081 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4082 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4083 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4084 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4085 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4086 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4087
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004088 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4089 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4090 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4091
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004092 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4093 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4094
4095 Examples :
4096 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004097 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004098
4099 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004100 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004101
4102 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004103 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004104
4105 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004106 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004107
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004108 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004109
4110
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004111http-check send-state
4112 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4114 yes | no | yes | yes
4115 Arguments : none
4116
4117 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4118 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4119 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4120 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4121 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4122
4123 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4124 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4125 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4126 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4127 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004128 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4129 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4130 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4131
4132 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4133 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4134 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4135
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004136 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4137 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4138 checked in multiple backends.
4139
4140 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4141 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4142
4143 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4144 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4145 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4146 one fails.
4147
4148 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4149 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4150 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4151
4152 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4153 server's queue.
4154
4155 Example of a header received by the application server :
4156 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4157 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4158
4159 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161
4162http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004163 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4164
4165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4166 no | yes | yes | yes
4167
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004168 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4169 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4170 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4171 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4172 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004174 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4175 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004177 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179 Example:
4180 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4181 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4182 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004184 http-request allow if nagios
4185 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4186 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4187 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 Example:
4190 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4191 acl add path /addacl
4192 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004194 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4197 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004199 Example:
4200 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4201 acl setmap path /setmap
4202 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004206 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4207 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4210 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004212http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4215 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4216 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4217 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4218 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4219 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4220 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4221 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4226 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4227 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4228 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4229 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4230 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4231 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4232 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004236 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4237 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004238
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4243 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4244 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4245 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4246 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248 Example:
4249 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4250 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004251
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004252http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004253
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004254 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4257 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4260 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4261 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4262 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4263 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4264 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4265 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4266 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4267 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4270 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4271 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4272 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4273 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4274 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4279 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4280 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4281 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4282 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4283 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004285http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4292 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4293 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4294 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4295 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4296 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004298http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4301 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4302 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4303 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4304 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004305
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004306http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4307 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4308 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4309 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4310
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004311http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4312
4313 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4314 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4315 pointed by <resolvers>.
4316 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4317 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4318 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4319 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4320 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4321 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4322 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4323 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4324 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4325 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4326 to 0.0.0.0.
4327
4328 Example:
4329 resolvers mydns
4330 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4331 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4332 timeout retry 1s
4333 hold valid 10s
4334 hold nx 3s
4335 hold other 3s
4336 hold obsolete 0s
4337 accepted_payload_size 8192
4338
4339 frontend fe
4340 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4341 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4342 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4343
4344 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4345 # which mean DNS resolution error
4346 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4347
4348 default_backend be
4349
4350 backend b_503
4351 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4352 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4353 # 503 error page to end users
4354
4355 backend be
4356 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4357 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4358 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4359 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4360 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4361
4362 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4363 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4364
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004365http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4366
4367 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4368 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4369 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4370 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004371 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4372 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004373
4374 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4379 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4380 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4381 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4382 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4387 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4388 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4389 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004391http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4392 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004393
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004394 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4395 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4396 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4397 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4398 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4399 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004400
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004401 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4402 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4403 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4404 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4405 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004406
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004407 Example:
4408 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4409
4410 # applied to:
4411 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4412
4413 # outputs:
4414 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4415
4416 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004417
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004418 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4419
4420 # applied to:
4421 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004422
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004423 # outputs:
4424 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004425
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004426http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4427 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4428
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004429 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4430 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4431 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4432 against.
4433
4434 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4435 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4436 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004437
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004438 Example:
4439 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4440 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004442 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4443 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004444
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004445 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4446 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4447 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4448 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004450http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4451 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004452
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004453 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4454 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4455 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4456 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004457
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004458 Example:
4459 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004460
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004461 # applied to:
4462 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004463
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004464 # outputs:
4465 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004467http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4468http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4471 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4472 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004473
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004474http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4475 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004476
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004477 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4478 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4479 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4480 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004484 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4485 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4486 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4487 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4488 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004490 Arguments:
4491 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4492 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004494 Example:
4495 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4496 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004498 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4499 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004503 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4504 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4505 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004507 Arguments:
4508 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4509 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004511 Example:
4512 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4513 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004514
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004515 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4516 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4517 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004519http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004521 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4522 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4523 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4524 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4525 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004527 Example:
4528 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4529 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4530 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4531 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4532 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4533 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4534 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4535 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4536 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4541 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4542 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4543 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4544 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4547 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4550 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4551 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4552 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4553 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4554 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4555 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4556 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4557 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004559http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004561 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4562 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4563 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4564 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4565 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4566 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4567 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4572 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4573 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004575http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4578 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4579 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4580 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4581 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4582 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4583 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4584 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004588 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4589 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4590 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4591 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4592 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4593 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004595 Example :
4596 # prepend the host name before the path
4597 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004601 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4602 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4603 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4604 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4605 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004607http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4610 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4611 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4612 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4613 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4614 values have higher priority.
4615 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4616 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4617 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4618 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4619 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4624 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4625 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4626 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4627 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4628 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4629 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004632
4633 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004634 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4635 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4638 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4639 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4640 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4641 privacy.
4642
4643 Arguments :
4644 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4645 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004646
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004647 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4649 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4650
4651 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4652 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4653
4654http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4655
4656 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4657 expression.
4658
4659 Arguments:
4660 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4661 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004662
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004663 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004664 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4665 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4666
4667 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4668 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4669 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4670
4671http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4672
4673 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4674 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4675 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4676 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4677 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4678 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4679 information from the request.
4680
4681 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4682
4683http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4684
4685 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4686 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4687 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4688 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4689 path and the query string.
4690 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4691
4692http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4693
4694 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4695 inline.
4696
4697 Arguments:
4698 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4699 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4700 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4701 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4702 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4703 (request and response)
4704 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4705 processing
4706 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4707 processing
4708 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4709 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4710 and '_'.
4711
4712 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4713 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004714
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004715 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004718http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4719 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004721 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4722 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4723 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4724 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4725 agent name must be used.
4726
4727 Arguments:
4728 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4729
4730 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4731 configuration.
4732
4733http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4734
4735 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4736 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4737 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4738 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4739 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4740 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4741 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4742 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4743 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4744 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4745 action.
4746 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4747 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4748 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4749 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4750 you fully understand how it works.
4751
4752http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4753
4754 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4755 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4756 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4757 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4758 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4759 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4760 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4761 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4762 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4763 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4764 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4765 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4766 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4767
4768http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4769http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4770http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4771
4772 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4773 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4774 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4775 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4776 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4777 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4778 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4779 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4780 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4781 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4782 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4783 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4784
4785 Arguments :
4786 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4787 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4788 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4789 select which table entry to update the counters.
4790
4791 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4792 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4793 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4794 that table until the session ends.
4795
4796 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4797 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4798 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4799 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4800 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4801 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4802 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4803 useful information.
4804
4805 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4806 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4807 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4808 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4809 checks that make use of it.
4810
4811http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4812
4813 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004814
4815 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004816 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004817
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004818http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4819
4820 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4821 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4822 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4823 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4824 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4825 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4826
4827 Arguments :
4828 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4829
4830 Example:
4831 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004833http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004834
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004835 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4836 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4837 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004838
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004841 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4842
4843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4844 no | yes | yes | yes
4845
4846 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4847 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4848 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4849 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4850 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4851 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4852
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004853 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4854 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004856 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004857
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004858 Example:
4859 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004860
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004861 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4864 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004866 Example:
4867 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004868
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004869 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004870
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004871 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4872 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004873
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004874 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4875 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004876
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004877http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004878
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004879 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4880 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4881 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4882 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4883 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4884 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4885 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4886 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004887
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004888http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004890 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4891 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4892 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4893 example, or to pass some internal information.
4894 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4895 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4896 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004900 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4901 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004902
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004903http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004904
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004905 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004907http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004909 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4910 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4911 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4912 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4913 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4914 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4915 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004917 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4918 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4919 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4920 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4921 keyword.
4922 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4923 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004927 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4928 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4929 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4930 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4931 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4932 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004934http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004936 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004938http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004940 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4941 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4942 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4943 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4944 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4945 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004947http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004949 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4950 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004952http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4955 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4956 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4957 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4958 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4959 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004960
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004961http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004963
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004964 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
4965 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004967 Example:
4968 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004970 # applied to:
4971 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004973 # outputs:
4974 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004976 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4979 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004980
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004981 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
4982 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004984 Example:
4985 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004987 # applied to:
4988 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004990 # outputs:
4991 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004993http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4994http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004996 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4997 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4998 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004999
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005000http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5001 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005002
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005003 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5004 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5005 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5006 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005008http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005010 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5011 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5012 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5013 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5014 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 Arguments:
5017 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5020 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005022http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5025 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5026 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005028http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5029
5030 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5031 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5032 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5033 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5034 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5035
5036http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5037
5038 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5039 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5040 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5041 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5042 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5043 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5044 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5045 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5046 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5047
5048http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5049
5050 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5051 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5052 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5053 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5054 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5055 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5056 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5057
5058http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5059
5060 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5061 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5062 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5063 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5064 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5065 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5066 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5067 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5068
5069http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5070 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5071
5072 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5073 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5074 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5075 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005076
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005077 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5079 http-response set-status 431
5080 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5081 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005083http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005085 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5086 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5087 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5088 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5089 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5090 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5091 based on some information from the request.
5092
5093 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5094
5095http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5096
5097 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5098 inline.
5099
5100 Arguments:
5101 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5102 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5103 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5104 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5105 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5106 (request and response)
5107 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5108 processing
5109 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5110 processing
5111 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5112 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5113 and '_'.
5114
5115 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5116 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005117
5118 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005119 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005121http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005123 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5124 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5125 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5126 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5127 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5128 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5129 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5130 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5131 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5132 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5133 action.
5134 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5135 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5136 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5137 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5138 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005140http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5141http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5142http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005144 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5145 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5146 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5147 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5148 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5149 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5150
5151http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5152
5153 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5154 about <var-name>.
5155
5156 Example:
5157 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5158
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005159
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005160http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5161 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5162
5163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | no | yes | yes
5165
5166 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005167 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5168 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5169 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005170
5171 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5172
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005173 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5174 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5175 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5176 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5177 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5178 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5179 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5180 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5181 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5182 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005183
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005184 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5185 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5186 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5187 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5188 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5189 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5190 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5191 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005192
5193 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5194 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5195 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5196 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5197 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5198 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5199 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5200 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005201 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005202 downsides of rare connection failures.
5203
5204 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5205 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5206 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5207 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5208 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5209 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005210 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005211 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5212 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5213 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5214 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5215 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5216
5217 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005218 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5219 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5220 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005221
5222 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005223 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005224
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005225 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5226 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005227
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005228 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005229
5230 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5231 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5232 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5233
5234 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5235
5236
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005237http-send-name-header [<header>]
5238 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5240 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005241 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005242 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5243
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005244 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5245 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5246 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5247 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5248 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5249 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5250 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5251 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5252 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5253 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5254 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5255 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5256 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5257 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5258 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5259 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005260
5261 See also : "server"
5262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005263id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005264 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 no | yes | yes | yes
5267 Arguments : none
5268
5269 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5270 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5271 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005272
5273
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005274ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5275 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5276 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005277 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005278
5279 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5280 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5281 and running).
5282
5283 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5284 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5285 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005286 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005287 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5288
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005289 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5290 "unless" condition is met.
5291
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005292 Example:
5293 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5294 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5295 ignore-persist if url_static
5296
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005297 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5298
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005299load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5300 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5301 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5302 yes | no | yes | yes
5303
5304 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5305 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5306 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005307 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005308 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5309 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5310 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5311 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5312
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005313 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005314 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005315 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005316
5317 Arguments:
5318 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5319 named "server-state-file".
5320
5321 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5322 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5323 name is used as a file name.
5324
5325 none don't load any stat for this backend
5326
5327 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005328 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5329 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5330 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005331 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005332 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005333
5334 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5335 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5336
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005337 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005338
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005339 global
5340 stats socket /tmp/socket
5341 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005342
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005343 defaults
5344 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005345
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005346 backend bk
5347 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5348 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005349
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005350
5351 Then one can run :
5352
5353 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5354
5355 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5356
5357 1
5358 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5359 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5360 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5361
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005362 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005363
5364 global
5365 stats socket /tmp/socket
5366 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5367
5368 defaults
5369 load-server-state-from-file local
5370
5371 backend bk
5372 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5373 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5374
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005375
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005376 Then one can run :
5377
5378 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5379
5380 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5381
5382 1
5383 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5384 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5385 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5386
5387 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5388 "show servers state"
5389
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005390
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005391log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005392log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5393 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005394no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005395 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5397 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005398
5399 Prefix :
5400 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5401 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5402 prefix does not allow arguments.
5403
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005404 Arguments :
5405 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5406 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5407 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5408 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5409 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5410 parameter.
5411
5412 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5413 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5414
5415 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5416 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5417 standard syslog port).
5418
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005419 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5420 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5421 standard syslog port).
5422
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005423 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5424 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5425 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005426 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005427
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005428 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5429 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5430 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5431 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5432 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5433 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5434 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5435 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5436 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5437 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5438 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5439 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5440 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5441 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5442 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5443 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005444 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5445 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005446
5447 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5448 and "fd@2", see above.
5449
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005450 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5451 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5452 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5453 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5454 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5455 having the logs instantly available.
5456
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005457 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5458 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005459
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005460 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5461 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5462 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5463 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5464 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5465 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5466 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5467 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5468 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5469 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005470 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005471
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005472 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5473 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5474 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5475 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5476 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5477
5478 <sample_size>
5479 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5480 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5481 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5482 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5483 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5484
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005485 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5486 one of the following :
5487
5488 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5489 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5490
5491 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5492 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5493
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005494 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5495 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5496 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5497 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5498 systemd logger consumes.
5499
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005500 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5501 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5502 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5503 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005505 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5506
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005507 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5508 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5509 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5510
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005511 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5512 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5513 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5514 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005515
5516 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5517 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5518 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005519 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5520 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5521 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5522 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5523 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005524
5525 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5526
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005527 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5528 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5529 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005530
5531 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5532 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5533 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5534 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5535
5536 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5537 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005538
5539 Example :
5540 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005541 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5542 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5543 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005544 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5545 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005546 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005548
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005549log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005550 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5551 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5552 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005553
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005554 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5555 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5556 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5557 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5558 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005559
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005560 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5561 "option httplog" directives.
5562
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005563log-format-sd <string>
5564 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5565 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5566 yes | yes | yes | no
5567
5568 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5569 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5570 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5571 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5572 which covers the log format string in depth.
5573
5574 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5575 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5576
5577 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5578 log format to "rfc5424".
5579
5580 Example :
5581 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5582
5583
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005584log-tag <string>
5585 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5587 yes | yes | yes | yes
5588
5589 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5590 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5591 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5592 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5593 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5594 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5595 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5596 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5597 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005598
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005599max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5600 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5602 yes | no | yes | yes
5603
5604 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5605 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5606 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5607 servers.
5608
5609 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5610 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5611 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5612 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5613 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005614 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005615 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5616 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5617 picking a different server.
5618
5619 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5620 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5621 even if they have to be queued.
5622
5623 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5624 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5625
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005626max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5627 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5628 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5629 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005630
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005631maxconn <conns>
5632 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5634 yes | yes | yes | no
5635 Arguments :
5636 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5637 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5638 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5639 closes.
5640
5641 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5642 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5643 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5644 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005645 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5646 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5647 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5648 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005649
5650 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5651 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5652 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5653
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005654 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5655 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005656
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005657 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5658
5659
5660mode { tcp|http|health }
5661 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5663 yes | yes | yes | yes
5664 Arguments :
5665 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5666 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5667 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5668 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5669
5670 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5671 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5672 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5673 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5674 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5675
5676 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005677 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5678 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5679 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5680 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5681 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5682 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5683 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005684
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005685 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5686 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5687 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005688
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005689 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005690 defaults http_instances
5691 mode http
5692
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005693 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005695
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005696monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005697 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005700 Arguments :
5701 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5702 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005703 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005704 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5705 backend and its backup.
5706
5707 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5708 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5709 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5710 servers in a list of backends.
5711
5712 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5713 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5714 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5715 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5716 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5717 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5718 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005719 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5720 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005721
5722 Example:
5723 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005724 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005725 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5726 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5727 monitor-uri /site_alive
5728 monitor fail if site_dead
5729
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005730 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005731
5732
5733monitor-net <source>
5734 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5736 yes | yes | yes | no
5737 Arguments :
5738 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5739 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5740 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5741 followed by a mask.
5742
5743 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5744 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005745 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005746 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5747
5748 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5749 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5750 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5751 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005752 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5753 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5754 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005755
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005756 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5757 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5758 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5759 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5760 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5761 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005762
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005763 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5764 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005765
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005766 Example :
5767 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5768 frontend www
5769 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5770
5771 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5772
5773
5774monitor-uri <uri>
5775 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5777 yes | yes | yes | no
5778 Arguments :
5779 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5780 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5781
5782 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5783 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5784 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5785 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5786 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5787 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5788 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5789 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5790
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005791 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005792 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5793 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5794 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5795 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5796 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5797 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005798
5799 Example :
5800 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5801 frontend www
5802 mode http
5803 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5804
5805 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005807
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005808option abortonclose
5809no option abortonclose
5810 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5812 yes | no | yes | yes
5813 Arguments : none
5814
5815 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5816 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5817 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5818 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005819 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005820 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5821 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5822 encountered while delivering the response.
5823
5824 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5825 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5826 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5827 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5828 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5829 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005830 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005831 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005832 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005833 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5834 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5835 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5836
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005837 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5838 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005839 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5840 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5841 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5842 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5843 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5844 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005845 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005846
5847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5849
5850 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5851
5852
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005853option accept-invalid-http-request
5854no option accept-invalid-http-request
5855 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | yes | yes | no
5858 Arguments : none
5859
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005860 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005861 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005862 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005863 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5864 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5865 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5866 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5867 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005868 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5869 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5870 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5871 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005872 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005873 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005874 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5875 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5876 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005877
5878 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5879 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5880 been confirmed.
5881
5882 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5883 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005884 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5885 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005886 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5887
5888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5890
5891 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5892 stats socket.
5893
5894
5895option accept-invalid-http-response
5896no option accept-invalid-http-response
5897 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | no | yes | yes
5900 Arguments : none
5901
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005902 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005903 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005904 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005905 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5906 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5907 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5908 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5909 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005910 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5911 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5912 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005913
5914 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5915 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5916 been confirmed.
5917
5918 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5919 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5920 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5921 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5922
5923 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5924 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5925
5926 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5927 stats socket.
5928
5929
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005930option allbackups
5931no option allbackups
5932 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5934 yes | no | yes | yes
5935 Arguments : none
5936
5937 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5938 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5939 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5940 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5941 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5942 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5943 order between the backup servers anymore.
5944
5945 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5946 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5947
5948 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5949 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5950
5951
5952option checkcache
5953no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005954 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5956 yes | no | yes | yes
5957 Arguments : none
5958
5959 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5960 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005961 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005962 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5963 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005964 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005965
5966 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005967 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005968 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005969 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5970 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005971 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005972 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005973 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5974 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005975 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005976 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5977 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005978 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005979 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5980 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5981 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5982 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5983 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5984 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5985 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5986 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5987 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5988
5989 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005990 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
5991 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
5992 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
5993 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005994
5995 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5996 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005997 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005998 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005999
6000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6002
6003
6004option clitcpka
6005no option clitcpka
6006 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 yes | yes | yes | no
6009 Arguments : none
6010
6011 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6012 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006013 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006014 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6015
6016 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6017 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6018 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6019 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6020
6021 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6022 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6023 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6024 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6025 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6026
6027 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6028
6029 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6030 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6031 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6032
6033 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6034 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6035
6036 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6037
6038
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006039option contstats
6040 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6042 yes | yes | yes | no
6043 Arguments : none
6044
6045 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6046 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6047 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6048 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006049 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6050 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6051 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6052 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6053 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006054
6055
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006056option dontlog-normal
6057no option dontlog-normal
6058 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6060 yes | yes | yes | no
6061 Arguments : none
6062
6063 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6064 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6065 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6066 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6067 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6068 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6069 logged.
6070
6071 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6072 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6073 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006075 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006076 logging.
6077
6078
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006079option dontlognull
6080no option dontlognull
6081 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6083 yes | yes | yes | no
6084 Arguments : none
6085
6086 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6087 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6088 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6089 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6090 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6091 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006092 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6093 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6094 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006095
6096 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006097 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006098 would not be logged.
6099
6100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6102
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006103 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6104 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006105
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006106
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006107option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006108 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6110 yes | yes | yes | yes
6111 Arguments :
6112 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6113 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006114 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006115 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006116
6117 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6118 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6119 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6120 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6121 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6122 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6123 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006124 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6125 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6126 possible that the client has already brought one.
6127
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006128 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006129 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006130 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006131 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006132 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006133 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006134
6135 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6136 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6137 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6138 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6139 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6140 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6141 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6142
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006143 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6144 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6145 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6146 are under the control of the end-user.
6147
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006148 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006149 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6150 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006151 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6152 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6153 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006154
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006155 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006156 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6157 frontend www
6158 mode http
6159 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6160
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006161 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6162 backend www
6163 mode http
6164 option forwardfor header X-Client
6165
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006166 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006167 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006168
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006169
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006170option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6171no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6172 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6174 yes | yes | yes | no
6175 Arguments : none
6176
6177 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6178 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6179 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6180 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6181 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6182 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6183 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6184
6185 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6186 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6187 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6188 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6189 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6190 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6191 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6192 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6193 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6194 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6195
6196 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6197
6198 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6199 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6200
6201 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6202 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6203
6204
6205option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6206no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6207 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6209 yes | no | yes | yes
6210 Arguments : none
6211
6212 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6213 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6214 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6215 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6216 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6217 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6218 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6219
6220 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6221 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6222 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6223 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6224 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6225 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6226 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6227 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6228 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6229 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6230
6231 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6232
6233 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6234 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6235
6236 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6237 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6238
6239
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006240option http-buffer-request
6241no option http-buffer-request
6242 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6244 yes | yes | yes | yes
6245 Arguments : none
6246
6247 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6248 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6249 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6250 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6251 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6252 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006253 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6254 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6255 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6256 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006257
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006258 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006259
6260
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006261option http-ignore-probes
6262no option http-ignore-probes
6263 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6265 yes | yes | yes | no
6266 Arguments : none
6267
6268 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6269 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6270 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6271 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6272 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6273 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6274 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6275 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6276 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006277 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6278 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006279 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6280
6281 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6282 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6283 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6284 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6285 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6286 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6287 are often the only way to detect them.
6288
6289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6291
6292 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6293
6294
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006295option http-keep-alive
6296no option http-keep-alive
6297 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6299 yes | yes | yes | yes
6300 Arguments : none
6301
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006302 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6303 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006304 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6305 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006306 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6307 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6308 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006309
6310 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6311 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006312 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6313 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6314 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6315 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6316 situations where this option may be useful :
6317
6318 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006319 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006320
6321 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6322 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6323
6324 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6325 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6326 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6327 request.
6328
6329 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6330 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006331 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6332 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6333 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006334
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006335 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6336 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6337 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6338 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6339 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6340 not set.
6341
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006342 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6343 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6344 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006345
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006346 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006347 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006348 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006349
6350
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006351option http-no-delay
6352no option http-no-delay
6353 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6355 yes | yes | yes | yes
6356 Arguments : none
6357
6358 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6359 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6360 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6361 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6362 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6363 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6364 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6365 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6366 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6367 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6368 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6369 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6370 affected.
6371
6372 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6373 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6374 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6375 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6376 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6377 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6378 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6379 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6380 latency environments.
6381
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006382 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6383
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006384
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006385option http-pretend-keepalive
6386no option http-pretend-keepalive
6387 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006389 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006390 Arguments : none
6391
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006392 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006393 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6394 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6395 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6396 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6397 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6398 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6399 consider the response complete.
6400
6401 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6402 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6403 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6404 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006405 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006406 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6407
6408 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6409 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6410 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6411 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6412 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6413 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6414 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6415
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006416 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6417 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6418 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6419 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6420 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6421 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006422
6423 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6424 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6425
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006426 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006427 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006428
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006429
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006430option http-server-close
6431no option http-server-close
6432 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6434 yes | yes | yes | yes
6435 Arguments : none
6436
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006437 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6438 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6439 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6440 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006441 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6442 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6443 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6444 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6445 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6446 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6447 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6448 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6449 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6450 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6451 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006452
6453 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6454 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6455 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6456 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006457 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6458 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006459
6460 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6461 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006462 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6463 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6464 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006465
6466 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6467 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6468
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006469 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6470 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006471
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006472option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006473no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006474 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6476 yes | yes | yes | no
6477 Arguments : none
6478
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006479 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006480 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6481 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6482 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6483 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6484 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6485 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6486
6487 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6488 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006489 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6490 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6491 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006492
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006493 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6494 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6495 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6496 front of an existing proxy.
6497
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006498 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6499
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006500 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006501
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006502option httpchk
6503option httpchk <uri>
6504option httpchk <method> <uri>
6505option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6506 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 yes | no | yes | yes
6509 Arguments :
6510 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6511 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6512 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6513 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6514 ones.
6515
6516 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6517 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6518 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6519
6520 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6521 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6522 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6523 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6524 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6525
6526 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6527 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6528 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6529 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6530 the lack of any response.
6531
6532 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6533
6534 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6535 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6536 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6537
6538 Examples :
6539 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6540 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6541 backend https_relay
6542 mode tcp
6543 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6544 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6545
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006546 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6547 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6548 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006549
6550
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006551option httpclose
6552no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006553 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6555 yes | yes | yes | yes
6556 Arguments : none
6557
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006558 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6559 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6560 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6561 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006562 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006563
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006564 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6565 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006566 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006567 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6568 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006569
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006570 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6571 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6572 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006573
6574 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6575 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006576 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6577 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6578 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006579
6580 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6581 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6582
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006583 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006584
6585
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006586option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006587 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006589 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006590 Arguments :
6591 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6592 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6593 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006594 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006595 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006596
6597 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6598 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6599 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6600 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6601 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6602 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6603 ports.
6604
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006605 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6606 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006607
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006608 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006610 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006611
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006612
6613option http_proxy
6614no option http_proxy
6615 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6617 yes | yes | yes | yes
6618 Arguments : none
6619
6620 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6621 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6622 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6623 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6624 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6625
6626 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6627 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006628 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6629 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006630
6631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6633
6634 Example :
6635 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6636 backend direct_forward
6637 option httpclose
6638 option http_proxy
6639
6640 See also : "option httpclose"
6641
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006642
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006643option independent-streams
6644no option independent-streams
6645 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6647 yes | yes | yes | yes
6648 Arguments : none
6649
6650 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6651 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6652 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6653 receive data or not.
6654
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006655 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006656 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6657 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6658 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6659 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6660 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6661 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6662 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6663 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6664 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6665 socket buffers.
6666
6667 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6668 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6669 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6670 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6671 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6672
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006673 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006674
6675
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006676option ldap-check
6677 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6679 yes | no | yes | yes
6680 Arguments : none
6681
6682 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6683 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6684 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6685 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6686
6687 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6688 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6689
6690 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6691 configure it.
6692
6693 Example :
6694 option ldap-check
6695
6696 See also : "option httpchk"
6697
6698
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006699option external-check
6700 Use external processes for server health checks
6701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6702 yes | no | yes | yes
6703
6704 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6705 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6706 command".
6707
6708 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6709
6710 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6711
6712
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006713option log-health-checks
6714no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006715 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6717 yes | no | yes | yes
6718 Arguments : none
6719
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006720 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6721 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6722 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006723
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006724 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6725 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6726 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6727 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6728 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6729
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006730 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006731 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006732
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006733 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6734 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6735 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006736
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006737
6738option log-separate-errors
6739no option log-separate-errors
6740 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6742 yes | yes | yes | no
6743 Arguments : none
6744
6745 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6746 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6747 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6748 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6749 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6750 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6751 provides very important information.
6752
6753 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6754 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6755 error logs.
6756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006757 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006758 logging.
6759
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006760
6761option logasap
6762no option logasap
6763 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6765 yes | yes | yes | no
6766 Arguments : none
6767
6768 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6769 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6770 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6771 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6772 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6773 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6774 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006775 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006776 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6777 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6778
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006779 Examples :
6780 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6781 mode http
6782 option httplog
6783 option logasap
6784 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6785
6786 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6787 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6788 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6789 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006791 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006792 logging.
6793
6794
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006795option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006796 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6798 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006799 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006800 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6801 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006802 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006803
6804 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6805 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006806 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006807 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6808 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6809 in the MySQL table, like this :
6810
6811 USE mysql;
6812 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6813 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6814
6815 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006816 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006817 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6818 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6819 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6820 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6821 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6822 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6823 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6824
6825 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6826 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006827
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006828 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006829
6830 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6831 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6832 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6833 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006834 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6835 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006836
6837 See also: "option httpchk"
6838
6839
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006840option nolinger
6841no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006842 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6844 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006845 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006846
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006847 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006848 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6849 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6850 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6851 connections.
6852
6853 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6854 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6855 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6856 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6857 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6858 this too.
6859
6860 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6861 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6862 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6863
6864 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6865 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6866 for servers.
6867
6868 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6869 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6870
6871
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006872option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6873 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 yes | yes | yes | yes
6876 Arguments :
6877 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6878 matching <network>
6879 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6880 header name.
6881
6882 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6883 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6884 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6885 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6886 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6887 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6888 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6889 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6890 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6891 possible that the client has already brought one.
6892
6893 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6894 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6895 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6896 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6897 header and requires different one.
6898
6899 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6900 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6901 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6902 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6903 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6904 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6905 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6906
6907 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6908 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6909 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6910 both are defined.
6911
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006912 Examples :
6913 # Original Destination address
6914 frontend www
6915 mode http
6916 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6917
6918 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6919 backend www
6920 mode http
6921 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6922
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006923 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006924
6925
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006926option persist
6927no option persist
6928 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6930 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006931 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006932
6933 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6934 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6935 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6936 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6937 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6938 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6939 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6940 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6941 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6942 redirected to another valid server.
6943
6944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6946
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006947 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006948
6949
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006950option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6951 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6953 yes | no | yes | yes
6954 Arguments :
6955 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6956 PostgreSQL server.
6957
6958 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6959 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6960 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6961 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6962
6963 See also: "option httpchk"
6964
6965
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006966option prefer-last-server
6967no option prefer-last-server
6968 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6970 yes | no | yes | yes
6971 Arguments : none
6972
6973 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6974 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6975 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6976 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6977 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6978 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6979 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6980 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6981 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006982 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6983 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006984 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6985 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6986 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006987 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6988 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6989 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006990
6991 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6992 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6993
6994 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6995
6996
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006997option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006998option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006999no option redispatch
7000 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7002 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007003 Arguments :
7004 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7005 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7006 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007007 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007008 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007009 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007010 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7011 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7012 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007014
7015 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7016 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7017 be able to access the service anymore.
7018
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007019 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7020 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007021
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007022 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007023 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7024 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007026 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7027 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7028
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007029 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007030
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007031
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007032option redis-check
7033 Use redis health checks for server testing
7034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7035 yes | no | yes | yes
7036 Arguments : none
7037
7038 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7039 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7040 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7041 find the "+PONG" response message.
7042
7043 Example :
7044 option redis-check
7045
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007046 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007047
7048
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007049option smtpchk
7050option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7051 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7053 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007054 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007055 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007056 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007057 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7058
7059 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7060 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7061 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7062
7063 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7064 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7065 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7066 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7067 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7068 dead server.
7069
7070 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7071 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007072 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007073 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7074
7075 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7076 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7077 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7078 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007079 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007080
7081 Example :
7082 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7083
7084 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7085
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007087option socket-stats
7088no option socket-stats
7089
7090 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7092 yes | yes | yes | no
7093
7094 Arguments : none
7095
7096
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007097option splice-auto
7098no option splice-auto
7099 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7101 yes | yes | yes | yes
7102 Arguments : none
7103
7104 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7105 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007106 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007107 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007108 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007109 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7110 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7111 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7112 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7113
7114 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7115 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7116 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7117 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7118 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7119 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7120 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7121 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7122 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7123 keyword.
7124
7125 Example :
7126 option splice-auto
7127
7128 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7129 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7130
7131 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7132 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7133
7134
7135option splice-request
7136no option splice-request
7137 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7139 yes | yes | yes | yes
7140 Arguments : none
7141
7142 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007143 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007144 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7145 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7146 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7147 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7148
7149 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7150
7151 Example :
7152 option splice-request
7153
7154 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7155 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7156
7157 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7158 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7159
7160
7161option splice-response
7162no option splice-response
7163 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7165 yes | yes | yes | yes
7166 Arguments : none
7167
7168 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007169 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007170 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7171 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7172 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7173 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7174
7175 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7176
7177 Example :
7178 option splice-response
7179
7180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7182
7183 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7184 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7185
7186
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007187option spop-check
7188 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7190 no | no | no | yes
7191 Arguments : none
7192
7193 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7194 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7195 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7196 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7197
7198 Example :
7199 option spop-check
7200
7201 See also : "option httpchk"
7202
7203
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007204option srvtcpka
7205no option srvtcpka
7206 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7208 yes | no | yes | yes
7209 Arguments : none
7210
7211 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7212 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007213 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007214 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7215
7216 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7217 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7218 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7219 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7220
7221 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7222 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7223 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7224 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7225 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7226
7227 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7228
7229 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7230 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7231 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7232
7233 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7234 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7235
7236 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7237
7238
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007239option ssl-hello-chk
7240 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7242 yes | no | yes | yes
7243 Arguments : none
7244
7245 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7246 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7247 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7248 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7249 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7250 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7251 hello message.
7252
7253 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7254 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7255 messages, which is appreciable.
7256
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007257 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7258 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7259 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007260
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007261 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7262
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007263
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007264option tcp-check
7265 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7267 yes | no | yes | yes
7268
7269 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7270 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7271
7272 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7273 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7274 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7275
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007276 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007277 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7278 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7279 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7280 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7281 only.
7282
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007283 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007284 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7285 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7286 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7287 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7288
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007289 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007290 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7291 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007292 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007293 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7294 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7295 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7296 the respective protocols.
7297 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007298 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007299
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007300 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7301 script.
7302
7303 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7304 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7305 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7306 The "comment" is of course optional.
7307
7308
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007309 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007310 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007311 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007312 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007313
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007314 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007315 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007316 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007317
7318 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7319 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007320 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007321 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007322 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007323 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007324 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007325 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007326 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7327 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007328 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007329 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7330 tcp-check expect string +OK
7331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007332 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007333 (send many headers before analyzing)
7334 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007335 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007336 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7337 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7338 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7339 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007340 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007341
7342
7343 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7344
7345
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007346option tcp-smart-accept
7347no option tcp-smart-accept
7348 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7350 yes | yes | yes | no
7351 Arguments : none
7352
7353 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7354 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7355 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7356 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7357 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7358 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7359
7360 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7361 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7362 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7363 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7364
7365 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7366 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7367 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007368 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007369
7370 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7371 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7372 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7373
7374 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7375 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7376 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7377
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007378 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7379
7380
7381option tcp-smart-connect
7382no option tcp-smart-connect
7383 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7385 yes | no | yes | yes
7386 Arguments : none
7387
7388 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7389 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7390 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7391 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7392 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7393
7394 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7395 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7396 complex.
7397
7398 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7399 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7400 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7401
7402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7404
7405 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7406
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007407
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007408option tcpka
7409 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7411 yes | yes | yes | yes
7412 Arguments : none
7413
7414 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7415 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007416 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007417 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7418
7419 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7420 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7421 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7422 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7423
7424 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7425 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7426 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7427 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7428 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7429
7430 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7431
7432 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7433 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7434 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7435 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7436 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7437 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7438 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7439 backends.
7440
7441 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7442
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007443
7444option tcplog
7445 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007447 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007448 Arguments : none
7449
7450 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7451 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7452 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7453 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7454 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7455 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7456 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7457 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7458
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007459 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007461 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007462
7463
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007464option transparent
7465no option transparent
7466 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007468 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007469 Arguments : none
7470
7471 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7472 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7473 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7474 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7475 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7476 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7477 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7478 appropriate server.
7479
7480 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7481 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7482
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007483 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007484 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007485
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007486
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007487external-check command <command>
7488 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7490 yes | no | yes | yes
7491
7492 Arguments :
7493 <command> is the external command to run
7494
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007495 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7496
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007497 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007498
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007499 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7500 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7501 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7502 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7503 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7504 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007505
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007506 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7507
7508 Environment variables :
7509 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7510 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7511
7512 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7513
7514 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7515
7516 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7517 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7518 for a UNIX socket).
7519
7520 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7521
7522 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7523
7524 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7525
7526 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7527
7528 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7529
7530 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7531 socket).
7532
7533 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7534 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7535
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007536 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7537
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007538 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7539 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7540 failed.
7541
7542 Example :
7543 external-check command /bin/true
7544
7545 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7546
7547
7548external-check path <path>
7549 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 yes | no | yes | yes
7552
7553 Arguments :
7554 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7555
7556 The default path is "".
7557
7558 Example :
7559 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7560
7561 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7562 "external-check command"
7563
7564
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007565persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007566persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007567 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7569 yes | no | yes | yes
7570 Arguments :
7571 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007572 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7573 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007574
7575 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7576 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007577 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007578 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7579 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7580 forwarded to this server.
7581
7582 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7583 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7584 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007585 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007586 a single "listen" section.
7587
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007588 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7589 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7590 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7591
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007592 Example :
7593 listen tse-farm
7594 bind :3389
7595 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7596 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7597 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7598 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7599 persist rdp-cookie
7600 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007601 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007602 balance rdp-cookie
7603 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7604 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7605
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007606 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7607 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007608
7609
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007610rate-limit sessions <rate>
7611 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7613 yes | yes | yes | no
7614 Arguments :
7615 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7616 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7617
7618 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7619 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7620 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7621 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7622 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7623 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7624
7625 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7626 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7627 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7628 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7629
7630 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7631 listen smtp
7632 mode tcp
7633 bind :25
7634 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007635 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007636
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007637 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7638 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7639 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007640
7641 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7642
7643
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007644redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7645redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7646redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007647 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7649 no | yes | yes | yes
7650
7651 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007652 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007653
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007654 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007655 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007656 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7657 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7658 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007659
7660 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7661 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7662 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7663 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7664 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007665 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7666 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7667 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7668 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007669
7670 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7671 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7672 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7673 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7674 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7675 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007676 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007677 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007678 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7679 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7680 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007681
7682 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007683 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7684 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7685 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007686 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007687 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7688 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7689 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7690 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007691
7692 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007693 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007694
7695 - "drop-query"
7696 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7697 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7698 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7699 with a location-type redirect.
7700
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007701 - "append-slash"
7702 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7703 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7704 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7705 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7706
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007707 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7708 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7709 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7710 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7711 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7712 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7713 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7714
7715 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7716 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7717 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7718 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7719 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7720 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7721 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007722
7723 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7724 acl clear dst_port 80
7725 acl secure dst_port 8080
7726 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007727 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007728 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007729 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7730
7731 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007732 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7733 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7734 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007735 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007736
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007737 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7738 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7739 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7740
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007741 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007742 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007743
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007744 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007745 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7746 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7747 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007749 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007750
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007751
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007752retries <value>
7753 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7754 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7755 yes | no | yes | yes
7756 Arguments :
7757 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7758 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7759 default value is 3.
7760
7761 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7762 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7763 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7764
7765 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007766 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7767 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007768
7769 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7770 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7771
7772 See also : "option redispatch"
7773
7774
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007775retry-on [list of keywords]
7776 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7778 yes | no | yes | yes
7779 Arguments :
7780 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7781 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7782 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7783 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7784
7785 none never retry
7786
7787 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7788 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7789
7790 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7791 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7792 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7793 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7794 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7795 processing the request.
7796
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007797 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7798 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7799 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7800 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7801 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7802 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7803 overflow attack for example).
7804
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007805 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7806 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7807 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7808 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7809 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7810 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7811 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7812 amplify denial of service attacks.
7813
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007814 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7815 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7816 considered to be safe to retry.
7817
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007818 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7819 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7820 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7821 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7822
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007823 all-retryable-errors
7824 retry request for any error that are considered
7825 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7826 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7827 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7828
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007829 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7830 not cumulative.
7831
7832 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7833 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7834 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7835 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7836
7837 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7838 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7839 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7840 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7841 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7842 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7843 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7844 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7845 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7846 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7847 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7848 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7849
7850 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7851 should not use this directive.
7852
7853 The default is "conn-failure".
7854
7855 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7856
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007857server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007858 Declare a server in a backend
7859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7860 no | no | yes | yes
7861 Arguments :
7862 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007863 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007864 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007865
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007866 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7867 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7868 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7869 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007870 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7871 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7872 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7873 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7874 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007875 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7876 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7877 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7878 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7879 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7880 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7881 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007882 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007883 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7884 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7885 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7886 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7887 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7888 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007889 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7890 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007891 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7892 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007893
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007894 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007895 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7896 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7897 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7898 adding this value to the client's port.
7899
7900 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7901 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007902 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007903
7904 Examples :
7905 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7906 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007907 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007908 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7909 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7910 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007911
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007912 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7913 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7914 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7915 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7916 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7917
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007918 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7919 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007920
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007921server-state-file-name [<file>]
7922 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7923 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7924 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7925 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7926 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7927 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7928
7929 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7930 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7931
7932 global
7933 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7934
7935 backend bk
7936 load-server-state-from-file
7937
7938 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7939 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007940
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007941server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7942 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7943 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7945 no | no | yes | yes
7946
7947 Arguments:
7948 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7949
7950 <num | range>
7951 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7952 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7953 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7954 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7955
7956 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7957
7958 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7959
7960 <params*>
7961 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7962 keyword.
7963
7964 Examples:
7965 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7966 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7967 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7968
7969 # or
7970 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7971
7972 # would be equivalent to:
7973 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7974 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7975 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7976
7977
7978
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007979source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007980source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007981source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007982 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7984 yes | no | yes | yes
7985 Arguments :
7986 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7987 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007988
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007989 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007990 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7991 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7992 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7993 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7994 supported prefixes are :
7995 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7996 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7997 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007998 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007999 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8000 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008001
8002 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8003 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008004 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8005 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8006 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008007
8008 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8009 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8010 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8011 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8012 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8013 <addr>.
8014
8015 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8016 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8017 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8018 port.
8019
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008020 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8021 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8022 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8023 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008024 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008025 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8026 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8027 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8028 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8029 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8030 HTTP header.
8031
8032 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8033 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008034 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008035 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8036 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8037 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8038 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8039 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8040 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8041 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8042
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008043 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8044 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8045 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8046 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8047 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8048 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8049
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008050 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8051 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8052 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8053 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8054
8055 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8056 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8057 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8058 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8059 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8060 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8061
8062 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8063 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8064 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8065 there are two methods :
8066
8067 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8068 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8069 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8070 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8071 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8072 of the client ranges may be used.
8073
8074 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8075 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8076 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8077 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8078 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8079 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8080 same session.
8081
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008082 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8083 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8084 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008085 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008086
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008087 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8088
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008089 Examples :
8090 backend private
8091 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8092 source 192.168.1.200
8093
8094 backend transparent_ssl1
8095 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8096 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8097
8098 backend transparent_ssl2
8099 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8100 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8101 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8102
8103 backend transparent_ssl3
8104 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8105 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8106 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8107
8108 backend transparent_smtp
8109 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8110 # with Tproxy version 4.
8111 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8112
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008113 backend transparent_http
8114 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8115 # proxy.
8116 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008118 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008119 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8120
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008121
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008122stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8123 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008125 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008126
8127 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8128 matched.
8129
8130 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8131 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8132
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008133 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8134 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008135 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008136
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008137 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8138 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8139 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8140 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008141
8142 Example :
8143 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8144 backend stats_localhost
8145 stats enable
8146 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8147
8148 Example :
8149 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8150 backend stats_auth
8151 stats enable
8152 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8153 stats admin if TRUE
8154
8155 Example :
8156 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8157 userlist stats-auth
8158 group admin users admin
8159 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8160 group readonly users haproxy
8161 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8162
8163 backend stats_auth
8164 stats enable
8165 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8166 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8167 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8168 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8169
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008170 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8171 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8172 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008173
8174
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008175stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8176 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008178 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008179 Arguments :
8180 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8181
8182 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8183
8184 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8185 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8186 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8187 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8188 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8189 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8190
8191 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8192 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8193 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008194 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008195
8196 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8197 report using "stats scope".
8198
8199 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8200 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8201 unobvious parameters.
8202
8203 Example :
8204 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8205 backend public_www
8206 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8207 stats enable
8208 stats hide-version
8209 stats scope .
8210 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008211 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008212 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8213 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8214
8215 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8216 backend private_monitoring
8217 stats enable
8218 stats uri /admin?stats
8219 stats refresh 5s
8220
8221 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8222
8223
8224stats enable
8225 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008227 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008228 Arguments : none
8229
8230 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8231 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8232 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8233 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8234 - stats auth : no authentication
8235 - stats scope : no restriction
8236
8237 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8238 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8239 unobvious parameters.
8240
8241 Example :
8242 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8243 backend public_www
8244 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8245 stats enable
8246 stats hide-version
8247 stats scope .
8248 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008249 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008250 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8251 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8252
8253 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8254 backend private_monitoring
8255 stats enable
8256 stats uri /admin?stats
8257 stats refresh 5s
8258
8259 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8260
8261
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008262stats hide-version
8263 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008265 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008266 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008267
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008268 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8269 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8270 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8271 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8272 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8273 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008274
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008275 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8276 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8277 unobvious parameters.
8278
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008279 Example :
8280 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8281 backend public_www
8282 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008283 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008284 stats hide-version
8285 stats scope .
8286 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008287 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008288 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8289 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008290
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008291 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8292 backend private_monitoring
8293 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008294 stats uri /admin?stats
8295 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008296
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008297 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008298
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008299
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008300stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8301 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8302 Access control for statistics
8303
8304 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8305 no | no | yes | yes
8306
8307 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8308 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8309 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8310 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8311 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8312 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8313
8314 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8315 instance.
8316
8317 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8318 about ACL usage.
8319
8320
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008321stats realm <realm>
8322 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008324 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008325 Arguments :
8326 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8327 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8328 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8329
8330 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8331 using a backslash ('\').
8332
8333 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8334 only related to authentication.
8335
8336 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8337 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8338 unobvious parameters.
8339
8340 Example :
8341 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8342 backend public_www
8343 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8344 stats enable
8345 stats hide-version
8346 stats scope .
8347 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008348 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008349 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8350 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8351
8352 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8353 backend private_monitoring
8354 stats enable
8355 stats uri /admin?stats
8356 stats refresh 5s
8357
8358 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8359
8360
8361stats refresh <delay>
8362 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008364 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008365 Arguments :
8366 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8367 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8368 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8369 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8370 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8371 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8372
8373 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8374 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8375 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8376 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8377
8378 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8379 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8380 unobvious parameters.
8381
8382 Example :
8383 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8384 backend public_www
8385 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8386 stats enable
8387 stats hide-version
8388 stats scope .
8389 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008390 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008391 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8392 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8393
8394 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8395 backend private_monitoring
8396 stats enable
8397 stats uri /admin?stats
8398 stats refresh 5s
8399
8400 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8401
8402
8403stats scope { <name> | "." }
8404 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008406 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008407 Arguments :
8408 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8409 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8410 section in which the statement appears.
8411
8412 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8413 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8414 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8415 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8416 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8417 exists.
8418
8419 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8420 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8421 unobvious parameters.
8422
8423 Example :
8424 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8425 backend public_www
8426 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8427 stats enable
8428 stats hide-version
8429 stats scope .
8430 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008431 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008432 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8433 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8434
8435 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8436 backend private_monitoring
8437 stats enable
8438 stats uri /admin?stats
8439 stats refresh 5s
8440
8441 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8442
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008443
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008444stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008445 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008447 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008448
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008449 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008450 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8451
8452 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8453 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8454
8455 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8456 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008457 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008458
8459 Example :
8460 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8461 backend private_monitoring
8462 stats enable
8463 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8464 stats uri /admin?stats
8465 stats refresh 5s
8466
8467 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8468 global section.
8469
8470
8471stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008472 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8474 yes | yes | yes | yes
8475 Arguments : none
8476
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008477 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008478 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8479 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8480 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8481 - IP (socket, server)
8482 - cookie (backend, server)
8483
8484 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8485 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008486 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008487
8488 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8489
8490
8491stats show-node [ <name> ]
8492 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008494 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008495 Arguments:
8496 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8497 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8498
8499 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8500 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008501 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008502
8503 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8504 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8505 unobvious parameters.
8506
8507 Example:
8508 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8509 backend private_monitoring
8510 stats enable
8511 stats show-node Europe-1
8512 stats uri /admin?stats
8513 stats refresh 5s
8514
8515 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8516 section.
8517
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008518
8519stats uri <prefix>
8520 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008522 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008523 Arguments :
8524 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8525 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8526 query string.
8527
8528 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8529 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8530 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8531 possible to reach it in the application.
8532
8533 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008534 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008535 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8536 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8537 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8538 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8539
8540 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8541 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8542 an address or a port to statistics only.
8543
8544 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8545 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8546 unobvious parameters.
8547
8548 Example :
8549 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8550 backend public_www
8551 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8552 stats enable
8553 stats hide-version
8554 stats scope .
8555 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008556 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008557 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8558 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8559
8560 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8561 backend private_monitoring
8562 stats enable
8563 stats uri /admin?stats
8564 stats refresh 5s
8565
8566 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8567
8568
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008569stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8570 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008572 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008573
8574 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008575 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008576 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008577 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008578 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8579
8580 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8581 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8582 the "stick-table" statement.
8583
8584 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8585 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8586 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8587 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8588 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8589
8590 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8591 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8592 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8593 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8594 transformation rules.
8595
8596 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8597 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8598 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8599 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8600 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8601 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8602 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8603
8604 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8605 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8606 ACL based conditions.
8607
8608 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8609 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8610 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8611 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8612
8613 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8614 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8615 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8616 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8617
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008618 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8619 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008620 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008621
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008622 Example :
8623 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8624 # last 30 minutes
8625 backend pop
8626 mode tcp
8627 balance roundrobin
8628 stick store-request src
8629 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8630 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8631 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8632
8633 backend smtp
8634 mode tcp
8635 balance roundrobin
8636 stick match src table pop
8637 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8638 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8639
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008640 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008641 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008642
8643
8644stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8645 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8647 no | no | yes | yes
8648
8649 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8650 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8651 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8652 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8653
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008654 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8655 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008656 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008657
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008658 Examples :
8659 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008660 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008661
8662 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8663 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8664 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8665
8666
8667 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8668 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8669 backend http
8670 mode http
8671 balance roundrobin
8672 stick on src table https
8673 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8674 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8675 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8676
8677 backend https
8678 mode tcp
8679 balance roundrobin
8680 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8681 stick on src
8682 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8683 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8684
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008685 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008686
8687
8688stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8689 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8691 no | no | yes | yes
8692
8693 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008694 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008695 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008696 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008697 server is selected.
8698
8699 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8700 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8701 the "stick-table" statement.
8702
8703 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8704 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8705 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8706 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8707 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8708 address.
8709
8710 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8711 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8712 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8713 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8714 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8715 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8716 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8717 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8718 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8719 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8720
8721 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8722 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8723 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8724 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8725 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8726 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8727 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8728
8729 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8730 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8731 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8732 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8733
8734 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8735 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8736 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8737 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8738 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8739 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008740 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8741 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8742 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8743 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8744 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8745 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008746
8747 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8748 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8749 the request.
8750
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008751 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8752 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008753 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008754
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008755 Example :
8756 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8757 # last 30 minutes
8758 backend pop
8759 mode tcp
8760 balance roundrobin
8761 stick store-request src
8762 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8763 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8764 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8765
8766 backend smtp
8767 mode tcp
8768 balance roundrobin
8769 stick match src table pop
8770 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8771 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8772
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008773 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008774 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008775
8776
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008777stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008778 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8779 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008780 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008782 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008783
8784 Arguments :
8785 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8786 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8787 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8788 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8789
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008790 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8791 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8792 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8793 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8794
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008795 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8796 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8797 instance.
8798
8799 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8800 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8801 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8802 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8803 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8804 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008805 to 32 characters.
8806
8807 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8808 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8809 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008810 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008811 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8812 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008813
8814 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008815 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8816 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008817 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8818 increase.
8819
8820 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008821 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8822 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8823 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008824
8825 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8826 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8827 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8828 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008829 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008830 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8831 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8832 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8833 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8834 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8835 parameter (see below).
8836
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008837 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8838 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8839 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8840 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8841 soft restart.
8842
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008843 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8844 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008845
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008846 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8847 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8848 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8849 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008850 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008851 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008852 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8853 if not expiration delay is specified.
8854
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008855 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8856 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8857 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8858 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008859 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8860 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8861 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8862 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8863 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8864 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8865 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8866 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8867 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8868 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8869 types and their arguments.
8870
8871 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8872 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8873 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8874 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8875
8876 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8877 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8878 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008879 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008880
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008881 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8882 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8883 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008884 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008885 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008886 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008887
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008888 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8889 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8890 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8891 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8892
8893 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8894 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8895 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8896 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8897 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8898 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8899
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008900 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8901 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8902 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8903 they were received.
8904
8905 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8906 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8907 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8908 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8909 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8910
8911 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8912 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8913 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8914 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8915 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8916
8917 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8918 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8919 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8920
8921 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8922 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8923 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8924 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8925 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8926
8927 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8928 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8929 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8930 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8931 the client side.
8932
8933 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8934 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8935 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8936 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8937 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8938 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8939 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8940
8941 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8942 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8943 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8944 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8945 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8946 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008947 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008948
8949 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8950 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8951 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8952 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8953 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8954 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8955
8956 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008957 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008958 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8959 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8960
8961 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8962 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8963 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8964 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8965 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8966 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8967 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8968 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8969 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8970 recommended for better fairness.
8971
8972 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008973 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008974 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8975 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8976
8977 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8978 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8979 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8980 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8981 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8982 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8983 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8984 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8985 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8986 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008987
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008988 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8989 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008990 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8991 reference it.
8992
8993 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8994 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008995 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8996 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8997 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008998
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008999 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9000 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9001 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9002 something that can be ignored.
9003
9004 Example:
9005 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9006 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9007 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9008 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9009
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009010 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009011 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009012
9013
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009014stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009015 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9017 no | no | yes | yes
9018
9019 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009020 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009021 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009022 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009023 server is selected.
9024
9025 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9026 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9027 the "stick-table" statement.
9028
9029 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9030 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9031 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9032 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9033
9034 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9035 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9036 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9037 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9038 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9039 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009040 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009041 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9042 rules.
9043
9044 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9045 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9046 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9047 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9048 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9049 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9050 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9051
9052 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9053 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9054 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9055 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9056
9057 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9058 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9059 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9060 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9061 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9062 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009063 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9064 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9065 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9066 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9067 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9068 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9069 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9070 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9071 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009072
9073 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9074
9075 Example :
9076 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9077 backend https
9078 mode tcp
9079 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009080 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009081 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009082
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009083 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9084 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9085
9086 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9087 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9088 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9089
9090 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9091 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009092
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009093 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9094 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9095 # at offset 44.
9096
9097 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9098 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9099
9100 # Learn on response if server hello.
9101 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009102
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009103 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9104 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9105
9106 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9107 extraction.
9108
9109
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009110tcp-check connect [params*]
9111 Opens a new connection
9112 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9113 no | no | yes | yes
9114
9115 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9116 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9117 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9118
9119 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9120 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9121 of the sequence.
9122
9123 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9124 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9125 do.
9126
9127 Parameters :
9128 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9129 use the TCP connection.
9130
9131 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9132 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9133 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9134
9135 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9136
9137 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9138
9139 Examples:
9140 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9141 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9142 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9143 option tcp-check
9144 tcp-check connect
9145 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9146 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9147 tcp-check send \r\n
9148 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9149 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9150 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9151 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9152 tcp-check send \r\n
9153 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9154 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9155
9156 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9157 option tcp-check
9158 tcp-check connect port 110
9159 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9160 tcp-check connect port 143
9161 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9162 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9163
9164 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9165
9166
9167tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009168 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9170 no | no | yes | yes
9171
9172 Arguments :
9173 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9174 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9175 binary.
9176 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9177 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9178 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9179
9180 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9181 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9182 with the usual backslash ('\').
9183 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009184 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009185 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9186 used upper or lower case.
9187
9188
9189 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9190
9191 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9192 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9193 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9194 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9195 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9196 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9197 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9198 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9199
9200 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9201 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9202 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9203 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9204 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9205 expression.
9206
9207 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9208 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9209 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9210 this exact hexadecimal string.
9211 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9212
9213 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9214 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9215 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9216 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9217 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9218 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9219 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9220 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9221 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9222 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9223 the null character.
9224
9225 Examples :
9226 # perform a POP check
9227 option tcp-check
9228 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9229
9230 # perform an IMAP check
9231 option tcp-check
9232 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9233
9234 # look for the redis master server
9235 option tcp-check
9236 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009237 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009238 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9239 tcp-check expect string role:master
9240 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9241 tcp-check expect string +OK
9242
9243
9244 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9245 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9246
9247
9248tcp-check send <data>
9249 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9251 no | no | yes | yes
9252
9253 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9254 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9255
9256 Examples :
9257 # look for the redis master server
9258 option tcp-check
9259 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9260 tcp-check expect string role:master
9261
9262 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9263 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9264
9265
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009266tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9267 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009268 tcp health check
9269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9270 no | no | yes | yes
9271
9272 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9273 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009274 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009275 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9276 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9277 hexadecimal string.
9278 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9279
9280 Examples :
9281 # redis check in binary
9282 option tcp-check
9283 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9284 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9285
9286
9287 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9288 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9289
9290
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009291tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9292 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9294 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009295 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009296 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9297 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009298
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009299 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009300
9301 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9302 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009303 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9304 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9305 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9306 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9307 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9308 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009309
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009310 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9311 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9312 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9313 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009314
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009315 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009316 - accept :
9317 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9318 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9319 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009321 - reject :
9322 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9323 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9324 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9325 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9326 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9327 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9328 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9329 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9330 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9331 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9332 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009333 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009334
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009335 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9336 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9337 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9338 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9339 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9340 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9341 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9342 hosts.
9343
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009344 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9345 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9346 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9347 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9348 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9349 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9350 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9351 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9352
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009353 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9354 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9355 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9356 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9357 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9358 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9359 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9360 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9361 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009362 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9363 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009364
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009365 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009366 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009367 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9368 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9369 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009370 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009371 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9372 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9373 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9374 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9375 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9376 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9377 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9378 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009379
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009380 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009381 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009382 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009383 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009384 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9385 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9386 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009387
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009388 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9389 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9390 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9391 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009392
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009393 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9394 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9395 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9396 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9397 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009398 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9399 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9400 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9401 layer7 information is extracted.
9402
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009403 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9404 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9405 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9406 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9407 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009408
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009409 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9410 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9411 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9412 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9413
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009414 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9415 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9416 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9417 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9418
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009419 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9420 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9421 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9422 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9423 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009424
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009425 - set-src <expr> :
9426 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9427 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9428 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009429 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009431 Arguments:
9432 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9433 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009434
9435 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009436 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9437
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009438 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9439 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009440
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009441 - set-src-port <expr> :
9442 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9443 expression.
9444
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009445 Arguments:
9446 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9447 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009448
9449 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009450 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9451
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009452 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9453 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9454 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009455
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009456 - set-dst <expr> :
9457 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9458 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9459 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9460 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9461 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9462
9463 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9464 followed by some converters.
9465
9466 Example:
9467
9468 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9469 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9470
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009471 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9472 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9473
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009474 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9475 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9476 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9477 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9478
9479
9480 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9481 followed by some converters.
9482
9483 Example:
9484
9485 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9486
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009487 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9488 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9489 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9490
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009491 - "silent-drop" :
9492 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009493 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009494 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9495 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9496 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9497 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9498 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009499 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9500 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009501 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9502 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009503 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009504 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9505 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9506 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9507 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009509 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9510 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9511 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009512
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009513 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9514 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9515 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009516
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009517 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009518 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009519 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009520
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009521 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9522 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9523 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009525 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009526 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9527 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009528
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009529 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9530
9531 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9532
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009533 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9534
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009535 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009536
9537
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009538tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9539 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009541 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009542 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009543 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9544 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009545
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009546 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009548 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009549 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9550 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9551 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9552 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009553
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009554 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9555 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9556 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9557 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009558 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9559 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9560 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9561 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9562 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9563 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009564 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009565 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009567 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9568 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9569 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9570 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009571
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009572 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009573 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009574 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009575 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9576 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009577 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009578 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009579 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009580 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009581 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009582 - set-dst <expr>
9583 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009584 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009585 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009586 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009587 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009588 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009589
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009590 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9591 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009592 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9593 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009594
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009595 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9596 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9597 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9598 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9599 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9600 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009602 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009603 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9604 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009605
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009606 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009607 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9608 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9609 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9610 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009611 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9612 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9613 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009614
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009615 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009616 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9617 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9618 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009619
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009620 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9621 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9622
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009623 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009624 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9625 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009626
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009627 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9628 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009629 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009630 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9631 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009632 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009633 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009634 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009635 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9636 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009637 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009638 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9639 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009640
9641 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9642 followed by some converters.
9643
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009644 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9645 <var-name>.
9646
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009647 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9648 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9649 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9650 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9651 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9652
9653 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9654 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9655 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9656 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9657 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9658 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9659 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9660 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9661 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9662 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9663 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9664
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009665 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9666 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9667 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9668 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9669 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9670
9671 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9672
9673 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9674
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009675 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9676 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9677 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9678 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9679 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9680 evaluated.
9681
9682 Example:
9683 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9684
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009685 Example:
9686
9687 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009688 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009689
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009690 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009691 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9692 # and reject everything else.
9693 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9694 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009695 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009696 tcp-request content reject
9697
9698 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009699 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9700 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9701 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009702 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009703
9704 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9705 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9706 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009707 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009708 tcp-request content reject
9709
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009710 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009711 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009712 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009713 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009714 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9715 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009716
9717 Example:
9718 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9719 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009720 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009721
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009722 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009723 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009724
9725 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009726 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009727 # protecting all our sites
9728 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009729 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9730 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009731 ...
9732 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9733
9734 backend http_dynamic
9735 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009736 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009737 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009738 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009739 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009740 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009741 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009743 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009744
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009745 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9746 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009747
9748
9749tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9750 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009752 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009753 Arguments :
9754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9756 as explained at the top of this document.
9757
9758 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9759 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9760 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9761 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9762 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9763
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009764 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9765 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9766 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9767 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9768
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009769 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9770 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009771 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009772 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009773 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9774 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9775 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9776 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009777
9778 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9779 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9780 it pass through unaffected.
9781
9782 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9783 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9784 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009785 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009786 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9787 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009788 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9789 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9790 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009791
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009792 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009793 "timeout client".
9794
9795
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009796tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9797 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9799 no | no | yes | yes
9800 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009801 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9802 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009803
9804 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9805
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009806 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009807 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9808 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009809 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9810 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009811
9812 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9813
9814 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9815 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9816 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9817 inserted.
9818
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009819 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009820 - accept :
9821 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9822 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9823 the rules evaluation.
9824
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009825 - close :
9826 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9827 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9828 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9829 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9830 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9831 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009832 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009833 protocols.
9834
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009835 - reject :
9836 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9837 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009838 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009839
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009840 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9841 Sets a variable.
9842
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009843 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9844 Unsets a variable.
9845
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009846 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9847 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9848 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9849 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9850
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009851 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9852 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9853 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9854 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9855
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009856 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
9857 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9858 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9859 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9860 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009861
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009862 - "silent-drop" :
9863 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009864 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009865 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9866 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9867 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9868 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9869 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009870 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9871 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009872 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9873 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009874 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009875 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9876 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9877 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9878 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9879
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009880 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9881 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9882
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009883 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9884 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9885 for changing the default action to a reject.
9886
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009887 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9888 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9889 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9890 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009891 period.
9892
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009893 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9894 declared inline.
9895
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009896 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9897 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009898 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009899 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9900 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009901 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009902 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009903 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009904 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9905 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009906 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009907 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9908 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009909
9910 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9911 followed by some converters.
9912
9913 Example:
9914
9915 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9916
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009917 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9918 <var-name>.
9919
9920 Example:
9921
9922 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9923
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009924 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9925 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9926 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9927 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9928 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9929
9930 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9931
9932 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9933
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009934 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9935
9936 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9937
9938
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009939tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9940 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9942 no | yes | yes | no
9943 Arguments :
9944 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9945 below.
9946
9947 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9948
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009949 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009950 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9951 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9952 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9953 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9954 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9955 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9956 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009957 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009958 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9959 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9960 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9961 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9962 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9963 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9964 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9965 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9966 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9967 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9968 instead.
9969
9970 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9971 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9972 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9973 rules which may be inserted.
9974
9975 Several types of actions are supported :
9976 - accept : the request is accepted
9977 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9978 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9979 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009980 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009981 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009982 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009983 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009984 - silent-drop
9985
9986 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9987 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9988 sections for a complete description.
9989
9990 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9991 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9992 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9993
9994 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9995 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9996 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9997 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9998 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9999
10000 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10001 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10002
10003 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10004 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10005 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10006
10007 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10008 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10009 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10010
10011 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10012 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10013 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10014
10015 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10016 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10017 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10018
10019 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10020
10021 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10022
10023
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010024tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10025 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10027 no | no | yes | yes
10028 Arguments :
10029 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10031 as explained at the top of this document.
10032
10033 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10034
10035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010036timeout check <timeout>
10037 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10038 established.
10039
10040 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10041 yes | no | yes | yes
10042 Arguments:
10043 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10044 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10045 as explained at the top of this document.
10046
10047 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10048 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010049 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010050 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010051 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10052 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10053 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010054
10055 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10056 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10057
10058 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10059 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010060 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010061
10062 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10063 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10064 forget about it.
10065
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010066 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10067 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010068
10069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010070timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010071 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10073 yes | yes | yes | no
10074 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010075 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010076 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10077 as explained at the top of this document.
10078
10079 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10080 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10081 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010082 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10083 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10084 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10085 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010086 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10087 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10088 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010089 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010090 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010091 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10092 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010093 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10094 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010095
10096 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10097 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10098 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10099 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010100 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010101 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10102
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010103 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010104
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010105 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010106
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010107
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010108timeout client-fin <timeout>
10109 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10111 yes | yes | yes | no
10112 Arguments :
10113 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10114 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10115 as explained at the top of this document.
10116
10117 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10118 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10119 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10120 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10121 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10122 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10123 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010124 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10125 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10126 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010127
10128 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10129 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10130 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10131
10132 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10133
10134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010135timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010136 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10138 yes | no | yes | yes
10139 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010140 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010141 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10142 as explained at the top of this document.
10143
10144 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010145 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010146 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010147 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010148 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10149 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010150
10151 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10152 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10153 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10154 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010155 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010156 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10157
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010158 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010160
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010161timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10162 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10164 yes | yes | yes | yes
10165 Arguments :
10166 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10167 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10168 as explained at the top of this document.
10169
10170 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10171 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10172 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10173 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10174 once the request has started to present itself.
10175
10176 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10177 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10178 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10179 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10180 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10181
10182 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10183 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10184 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10185 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10186
10187 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10188 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010189 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010190 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10191 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010192 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010193
10194 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10195 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10196 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10197 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10198
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010199 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10200 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010201 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10202
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010203 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10204
10205
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010206timeout http-request <timeout>
10207 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010209 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010210 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010211 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010212 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10213 as explained at the top of this document.
10214
10215 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10216 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10217 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10218 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10219 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10220 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10221 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010222 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10223 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10224 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10225 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010226 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010227 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10228 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010229
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010230 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10231 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10232 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10233 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10234 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010235 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010236
10237 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10238 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010239 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010240 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10241 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10242
10243 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010244 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10245 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10246 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010247
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010248 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010249 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010250
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010251
10252timeout queue <timeout>
10253 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10255 yes | no | yes | yes
10256 Arguments :
10257 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10258 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10259 as explained at the top of this document.
10260
10261 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10262 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10263 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10264 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10265 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10266
10267 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10268 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10269 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10270 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10271
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010272 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010273
10274
10275timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010276 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10278 yes | no | yes | yes
10279 Arguments :
10280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10282 as explained at the top of this document.
10283
10284 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10285 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10286 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10287 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10288 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10289 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10290 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10291
10292 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10293 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10294 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10295 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10296 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010297 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010298 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010299 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10300 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010301 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10302 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010303
10304 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10305 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10306 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10307 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010308 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010309 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10310
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010311 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010312
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010313
10314timeout server-fin <timeout>
10315 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10317 yes | no | yes | yes
10318 Arguments :
10319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10321 as explained at the top of this document.
10322
10323 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10324 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10325 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10326 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10327 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10328 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10329 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10330 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10331 situations, it should not be needed.
10332
10333 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10334 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10335 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10336
10337 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10338
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010339
10340timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010341 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10343 yes | yes | yes | yes
10344 Arguments :
10345 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10346 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10347 as explained at the top of this document.
10348
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010349 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10350 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10351 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010352
10353 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10354 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10355 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10356 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010357 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010358
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010359 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010360
10361
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010362timeout tunnel <timeout>
10363 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10365 yes | no | yes | yes
10366 Arguments :
10367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10369 as explained at the top of this document.
10370
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010371 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010372 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10373 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10374 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010375 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10376 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010377 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10378 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10379 specified.
10380
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010381 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10382 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10383 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10384 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10385 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10386 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10387 state.
10388
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010389 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10390 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10391 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10392 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010393 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010394
10395 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10396 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10397 forget about it.
10398
10399 Example :
10400 defaults http
10401 option http-server-close
10402 timeout connect 5s
10403 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010404 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010405 timeout server 30s
10406 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10407
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010408 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010409
10410
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010411transparent (deprecated)
10412 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010414 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010415 Arguments : none
10416
10417 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10418 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10419 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10420 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10421 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10422 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10423 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10424 appropriate server.
10425
10426 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10427
10428 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10429 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10430
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010431 See also: "option transparent"
10432
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010433unique-id-format <string>
10434 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10436 yes | yes | yes | no
10437 Arguments :
10438 <string> is a log-format string.
10439
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010440 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10441 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10442 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10443 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010444
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010445 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10446 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10447 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10448 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10449 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10450 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10451 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10452 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010453
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010454 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10455 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010456
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010457 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010458
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010459 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010460
10461 will generate:
10462
10463 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10464
10465 See also: "unique-id-header"
10466
10467unique-id-header <name>
10468 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10470 yes | yes | yes | no
10471 Arguments :
10472 <name> is the name of the header.
10473
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010474 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10475 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010476
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010477 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010478
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010479 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010480 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10481
10482 will generate:
10483
10484 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10485
10486 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010487
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010488use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010489 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10491 no | yes | yes | no
10492 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010493 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10494 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010495
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010496 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10497 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010498
10499 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10500 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10501 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010502 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010503 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010504 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10505 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010506
10507 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10508 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10509 assign the backend.
10510
10511 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10512 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10513 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10514 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10515 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10516 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10517
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010518 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010519 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010520 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10521 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10522 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10523
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010524 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10525 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10526 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10527 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10528 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10529 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10530 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10531 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10532 cannot be forced from the request.
10533
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010534 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010535 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10536 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10537
10538 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10539 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010540
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010541use-fcgi-app <name>
10542 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10544 no | no | yes | yes
10545 Arguments :
10546 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10547
10548 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010549
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010550use-server <server> if <condition>
10551use-server <server> unless <condition>
10552 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10554 no | no | yes | yes
10555 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010556 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010557
10558 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10559
10560 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10561 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10562 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10563
10564 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10565 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10566 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10567 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10568 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10569 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10570 matches will assign the server.
10571
10572 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10573 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10574 with the next rules until one matches.
10575
10576 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10577 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10578 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10579 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10580
10581 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10582 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10583 stripped.
10584
10585 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10586 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10587 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10588 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10589
10590 Example :
10591 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10592 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10593 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10594 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10595 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10596 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010597 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010598 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10599 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10600
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010601 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010602
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010603
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100106045. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010605--------------------------
10606
10607The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10608depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10609settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10610written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10611described in this section.
10612
10613
106145.1. Bind options
10615-----------------
10616
10617The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10618as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10619no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10620parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10621while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10622provided immediately after the setting name.
10623
10624The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10625
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010626accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10627 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10628 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10629 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10630 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10631 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10632 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10633 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10634 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10635 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010636 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10637 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10638 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010639
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010640accept-proxy
10641 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010642 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10643 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010644 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10645 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10646 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10647 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010648 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010649 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10650 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010651 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10652 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010653
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010654allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010655 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010656 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010657 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010658 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10659 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010660
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010661alpn <protocols>
10662 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10663 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10664 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010665 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010666 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010667 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10668 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10669 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10670 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10671 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10672 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10673 preference, like below :
10674
10675 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010676
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010677backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010678 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010679 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10680
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010681curves <curves>
10682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10683 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10684 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10685 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10686 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10687 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10688
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010689ecdhe <named curve>
10690 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010691 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10692 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010693
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010694ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010695 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10696 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10697 client's certificate.
10698
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010699ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10700 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10701 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10702 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10703 error is ignored.
10704
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010705ca-sign-file <cafile>
10706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10707 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10708 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10709 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10710 'generate-certificates' for details.
10711
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010712ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10714 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10715 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10716 'generate-certificates' for details.
10717
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010718ciphers <ciphers>
10719 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10720 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010721 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010722 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010723 information and recommendations see e.g.
10724 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10725 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10726 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10727
10728ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10730 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10731 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10732 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010733 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10734 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010735
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010736crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010737 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10738 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10739 to verify client's certificate.
10740
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010741crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010742 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10743 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10744 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10745 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10746 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10747 file.
10748
10749 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10750 are loaded.
10751
10752 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010753 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010754 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10755 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10756 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10757 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010758 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10759 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010760 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010761
10762 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10763 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10764 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10765 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010766 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10767 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010768
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010769 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010771 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010772 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010773 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10774 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010775 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10776 clients).
10777
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010778 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10779 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10780 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10781 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10782 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10783 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10784 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10785 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10786 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10787 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10788 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10789 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10790 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10791
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010792 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10793 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10794 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10795 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10796 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10797
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010798 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10799 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10800 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10801 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010802
10803 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10804 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10805 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10806 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10807 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10808 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10809 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10810 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10811 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10812
10813 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10814
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010815 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010816 a cert bundle.
10817
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010818 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010819 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10820 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10821 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10822 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10823 provide multi-cert support.
10824
10825 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10826
10827 Filename | CN | SAN
10828 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10829 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010830 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010831 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10832 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10833
10834 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10835 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10836 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10837 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010838 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10839 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10840 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010841
10842 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10843 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10844
10845 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10846 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10847 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10848
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010849crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010851 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010852 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010853 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010854
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010855crt-list <file>
10856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010857 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10858 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010859
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010860 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10861
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010862 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10863 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010864 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010865 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010866
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010867 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10868 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10869 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10870 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10871 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10872 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10873 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10874 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010875
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010876 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010877 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010878 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10879 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10880 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010881
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010882 crt-list file example:
10883 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010884 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010885 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010886 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010887
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010888defer-accept
10889 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10890 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10891 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010892 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010893 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10894 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10895 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10896 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10897 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10898 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10899 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10900
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010901expose-fd listeners
10902 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10903 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010904 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10905 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010906 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010907
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010908force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010909 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010910 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010911 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010912 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010913
10914force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010915 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010916 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010917 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010918
10919force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010920 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010921 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010922 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010923
10924force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010925 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010926 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010927 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010928
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010929force-tlsv13
10930 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10931 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010932 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010933
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010934generate-certificates
10935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10936 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10937 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10938 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10939 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10940 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10941 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10942 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10943 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10944 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10945 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10946
10947 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10948 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010949 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010950 certificate is used many times.
10951
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010952gid <gid>
10953 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10954 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10955 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10956 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10957 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10958
10959group <group>
10960 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10961 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10962 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10963 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10964 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10965
10966id <id>
10967 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10968 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10969 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10970 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10971
10972interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010973 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10974 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10975 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10976 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10977 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10978 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010979 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10980 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10981 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10982 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10983 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10984 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010985
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010986level <level>
10987 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10988 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10989 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010990 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010991 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10992 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10993 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010994 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010995 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010996 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010997 all counters).
10998
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010999severity-output <format>
11000 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11001 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11002 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11003 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11004 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11005 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11006 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11007 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11008 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11009 rfc5424 convention.
11010
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011011maxconn <maxconn>
11012 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11013 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11014 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11015 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11016 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11017 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11018 eat all memory.
11019
11020mode <mode>
11021 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11022 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11023 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11024 UNIX sockets.
11025
11026mss <maxseg>
11027 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11028 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11029 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11030 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11031 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11032 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11033 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11034 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11035 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11036 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11037 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11038
11039name <name>
11040 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11041 page.
11042
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011043namespace <name>
11044 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11045 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11046 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11047 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11048
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011049nice <nice>
11050 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11051 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11052 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11053 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11054 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11055 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11056 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11057 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11058 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11059 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11060 one for an RDP socket.
11061
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011062no-ca-names
11063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11064 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11065
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011066no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011068 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011069 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011070 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011071 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11072 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011073
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011074no-tls-tickets
11075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11076 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11077 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011078 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11079 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011080
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011081no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011083 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011084 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011085 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011086 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11087 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011088
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011089no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011091 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011092 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011093 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011094 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11095 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011096
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011097no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011098 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011099 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011100 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011101 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011102 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11103 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011104
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011105no-tlsv13
11106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11107 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11108 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11109 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011110 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11111 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011112
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011113npn <protocols>
11114 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11115 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11116 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011117 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011118 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011119 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11120 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11121 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11122 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11123 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011124
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011125prefer-client-ciphers
11126 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11127 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11128 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011129 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11130 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11131 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011132
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011133process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011134 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011135 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011136 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011137 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11138 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11139 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11140 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011141 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011142 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11143 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11144 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11145 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11146 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011147
11148 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11149
11150 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11151 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11152 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11153 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11154 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11155 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11156 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11157 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011158
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011159proto <name>
11160 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11161 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11162 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11163 in haproxy -vv.
11164 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11165 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011166 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011167 h2" on the bind line.
11168
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011169ssl
11170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011171 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011172 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11173 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011174 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11175 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011176
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011177ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11178 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11179 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11180 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11181
11182ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11183 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11184 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11185 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11186
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011187strict-sni
11188 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11189 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11190 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11191 See the "crt" option for more information.
11192
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011193tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011194 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011195 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11196 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011197 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011198 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11199 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11200 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11201 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11202 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11203 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11204 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11205
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011206tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011207 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011208 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11209 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11210 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11211 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11212 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11213 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11214 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011215 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11216 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11217 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011218
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011219tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11220 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011221 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11222 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11223 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11224 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11225 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11226 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11227 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11228 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11229 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11230 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011231 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11232 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11233
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011234transparent
11235 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11236 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11237 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11238 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11239 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11240 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11241 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11242 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11243 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11244 so check for support with your vendor.
11245
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011246v4v6
11247 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11248 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11249 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11250 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011251 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011252
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011253v6only
11254 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11255 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11256 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011257 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11258 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011259
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011260uid <uid>
11261 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11262 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11263 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11264 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11265 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11266
11267user <user>
11268 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11269 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11270 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11271 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11272 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11273
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011274verify [none|optional|required]
11275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11276 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11277 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11278 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11279 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011280 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11281 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11282 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11283 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011284
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200112855.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011286------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011288The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11289which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11290arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11291settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11292after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11293Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11294address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011296 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011297 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011298
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011299Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11300keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011302The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011303
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011304addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011305 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011306 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11307 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11308 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11309 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11310 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011311
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011312agent-check
11313 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011314 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011315 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11316 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11317 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011318
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011319 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011320 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011321 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11322 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11323 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011324
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011325 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11326 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11327 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11328 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11329 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011330
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011331 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011332 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011333
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011334 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11335 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11336 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011337
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011338 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11339 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11340 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011341
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011342 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11343 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11344 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11345 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11346 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011347 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011348 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011349
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011350 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11351 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011352
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011353 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11354 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11355 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11356 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11357 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11358 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11359 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11360 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11361 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011362
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011363 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11364 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011365 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11366 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11367 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011368 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011369
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011370 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011371 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011372
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011373agent-send <string>
11374 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11375 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11376 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11377 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11378 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11379
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011380agent-inter <delay>
11381 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11382 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11383
11384 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11385 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11386 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11387 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11388 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11389 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11390 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11391 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11392 of backends use the same servers.
11393
11394 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11395
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011396agent-addr <addr>
11397 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11398
11399 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11400 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11401 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11402 hostname, it will be resolved.
11403
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011404agent-port <port>
11405 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11406
11407 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11408
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011409allow-0rtt
11410 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011411 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11412 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011413
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011414alpn <protocols>
11415 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11416 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11417 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011418 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011419 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11420 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11421 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11422 now obsolete NPN extension.
11423 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11424 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11425
11426 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011428backup
11429 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11430 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11431 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11432 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011433 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11434 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011435
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011436ca-file <cafile>
11437 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11438 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11439 server's certificate.
11440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011441check
11442 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011443 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11444 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11445 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11446 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11447 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11448 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11449 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011450 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11451 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011452 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11453 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011454
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011455check-send-proxy
11456 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11457 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11458 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11459 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11460 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11461 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11462 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11463
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011464check-alpn <protocols>
11465 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11466 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11467 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11468
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011469check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011470 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011471 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11472 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011473
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011474check-ssl
11475 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11476 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11477 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11478 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011479 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011480 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11481 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011482 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011483 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11484 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011485
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011486check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011487 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011488 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11489 for normal traffic.
11490
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011491ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11493 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11494 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011495 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11496 information and recommendations see e.g.
11497 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11498 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11499 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011500
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011501ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11502 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11503 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11504 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11505 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011506 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11507 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11508 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011510cookie <value>
11511 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11512 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11513 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11514 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11515 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11516 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11517 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11518
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011519crl-file <crlfile>
11520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11521 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11522 to verify server's certificate.
11523
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011524crt <cert>
11525 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11526 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11527 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11528 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11529 certificate request.
11530
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011531disabled
11532 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11533 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11534 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11535 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11536 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011537 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011538
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011539enabled
11540 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11541 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11542 default value.
11543 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11544 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011546error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011547 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11548 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11549 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011551 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011553fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011554 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11555 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11556 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11557
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011558force-sslv3
11559 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11560 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011561 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011562 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011563
11564force-tlsv10
11565 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011566 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011567 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011568
11569force-tlsv11
11570 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011571 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011572 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011573
11574force-tlsv12
11575 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011576 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011577 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011578
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011579force-tlsv13
11580 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11581 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011582 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011584id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011585 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11586 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11587 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011588
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011589init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11590 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11591 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011592 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011593 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11594 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11595 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11596 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11597 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11598 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11599 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11600 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11601 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011602 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011603 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11604 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11605 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11606 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11607 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11608 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011609 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011610
11611 Example:
11612 defaults
11613 # never fail on address resolution
11614 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011616inter <delay>
11617fastinter <delay>
11618downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011619 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11620 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11621 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11622 between checks depending on the server state :
11623
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011624 Server state | Interval used
11625 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11626 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11627 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11628 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11629 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11630 or yet unchecked. |
11631 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11632 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11633 | "inter" otherwise.
11634 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011636 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11637 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11638 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11639 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011640 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11641 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11642 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11643 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11644 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011645
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011646maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011647 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11648 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11649 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11650 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11651 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11652 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11653 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11654 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011656maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011657 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11658 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11659 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11660 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11661 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11662 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11663 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11664
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011665max-reuse <count>
11666 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11667 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11668 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11669 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11670 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11671 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11672 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11673 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011675minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011676 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11677 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11678 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11679 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11680 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11681 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011682 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011683 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011684
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011685namespace <name>
11686 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11687 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11688 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11689 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11690
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011691no-agent-check
11692 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11693 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11694 default value.
11695 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11696 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11697
11698no-backup
11699 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11700 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11701 default value.
11702 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11703 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11704
11705no-check
11706 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11707 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11708 default value.
11709 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11710 "default-server" "check" setting.
11711
11712no-check-ssl
11713 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11714 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11715 default value.
11716 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11717 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11718
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011719no-send-proxy
11720 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11721 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11722 default value.
11723 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11724 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11725
11726no-send-proxy-v2
11727 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11728 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11729 default value.
11730 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11731 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11732
11733no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11734 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11735 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11736 default value.
11737 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11738 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11739
11740no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11741 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11742 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11743 default value.
11744 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11745 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11746
11747no-ssl
11748 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11749 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11750 default value.
11751 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11752 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11753
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011754no-ssl-reuse
11755 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11756 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11757 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11758 and for paranoid users.
11759
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011760no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011761 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11762 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011763 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011764
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011765 Supported in default-server: No
11766
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011767no-tls-tickets
11768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11769 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11770 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011771 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11772 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011773 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011774
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011775no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011776 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011777 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11778 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011779 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11780 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011781 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011782
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011783 Supported in default-server: No
11784
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011785no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011786 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011787 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11788 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011789 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11790 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011791 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011792
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011793 Supported in default-server: No
11794
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011795no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011796 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011797 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11798 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011799 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11800 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011801 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011802
11803 Supported in default-server: No
11804
11805no-tlsv13
11806 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11807 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11808 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11809 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11810 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011811 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011812
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011813 Supported in default-server: No
11814
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011815no-verifyhost
11816 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11817 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11818 default value.
11819 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11820 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011821
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011822no-tfo
11823 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11824 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11825 default value.
11826 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11827 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11828
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011829non-stick
11830 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11831 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11832 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11833
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011834npn <protocols>
11835 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11836 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11837 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011838 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011839 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11840 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11841 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011843observe <mode>
11844 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11845 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11846 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11847 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11848 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11849 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011850 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011851
11852 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011854on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011855 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11856 Currently, four modes are available:
11857 - fastinter: force fastinter
11858 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11859 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11860 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11861 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11862
11863 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11864
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011865on-marked-down <action>
11866 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11867 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011868 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11869 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11870 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11871 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11872 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11873 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11874 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11875 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011876
11877 Actions are disabled by default
11878
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011879on-marked-up <action>
11880 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11881 Currently one action is available:
11882 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11883 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11884 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11885 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011886 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11887 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011888 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11889 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11890
11891 Actions are disabled by default
11892
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011893pool-max-conn <max>
11894 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11895 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11896 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11897 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11898 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11899 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11900
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011901pool-purge-delay <delay>
11902 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011903 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011904 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011906port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011907 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11908 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11909 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11910 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11911 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11912 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11913
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011914proto <name>
11915
11916 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11917 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11918 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11919 reported in haproxy -vv.
11920 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11921 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011923redir <prefix>
11924 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11925 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11926 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11927 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11928 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11929 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11930 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11931 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011932 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011933 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011934 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11935 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11936 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11937 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11938
11939 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011941rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011942 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11943 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11944 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11945
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011946resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11947 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11948 server.
11949
11950 Available options:
11951
11952 * allow-dup-ip
11953 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11954 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11955 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11956 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11957 For such case, simply enable this option.
11958 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11959
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050011960 * ignore-weight
11961 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
11962 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
11963 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
11964
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011965 * prevent-dup-ip
11966 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11967 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11968 same fqdn.
11969 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11970
11971 Example:
11972 backend b_myapp
11973 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11974 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11975 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11976
11977 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11978 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11979 it
11980 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11981 different address
11982
11983 Default value: not set
11984
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011985resolve-prefer <family>
11986 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11987 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11988 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11989 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11990
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011991 Default value: ipv6
11992
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011993 Example:
11994
11995 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011996
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011997resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011998 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011999 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012000 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012001 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12002 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012003 configured network, another address is selected.
12004
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012005 Example:
12006
12007 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012008
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012009resolvers <id>
12010 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12011 hostname.
12012
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012013 Example:
12014
12015 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012016
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012017 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012018
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012019send-proxy
12020 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12021 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12022 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12023 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012024 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12025 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12026 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12027 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12028 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12029 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12030 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12031 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12032 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12033 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012034 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12035 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012036
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012037send-proxy-v2
12038 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12039 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12040 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12041 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012042 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12043 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12044 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12045 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012046
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012047proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12048 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12049 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012050 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12051 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012052 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12053 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012054 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012055
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012056send-proxy-v2-ssl
12057 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12058 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12059 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12060 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12061 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12062 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12063 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012064 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12065 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012066
12067send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12068 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12069 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12070 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12071 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12072 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12073 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12074 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12075 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012076 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12077 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012079slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012080 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12081 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12082 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12083 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12084 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12085 parameters :
12086
12087 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12088 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12089
12090 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12091 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12092 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12093 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12094
12095 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12096 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12097 seen as failed.
12098
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012099sni <expression>
12100 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12101 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12102 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12103 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012104 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12105 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012106 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012107 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12108 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012109
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012110source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012111source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012112source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012113 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12114 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12115 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12116 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12117
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012118 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12119 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12120 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12121 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12122 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12123 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12124 server.
12125
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012126 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12127 specifying the source address without port(s).
12128
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012129ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012130 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12131 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12132 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12133 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12134 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12135 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012136 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12137 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012138
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012139ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12140 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12141 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12142 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12143
12144ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12145 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12146 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12147 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12148
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012149ssl-reuse
12150 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12151 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12152 default value.
12153 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12154 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12155
12156stick
12157 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12158 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12159 default value.
12160 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12161 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012162
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012163socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012164 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012165 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12166 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12167
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012168tcp-ut <delay>
12169 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12170 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12171 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012172 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012173 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12174 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12175 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12176 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12177 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12178 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12179 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12180 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12181 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12182
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012183tfo
12184 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12185 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12186 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12187 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12188 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012189 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012191track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012192 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12193 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12194 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12195 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012196 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12197
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012198tls-tickets
12199 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12200 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12201 default value.
12202 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12203 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012204
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012205verify [none|required]
12206 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012207 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012208 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12209 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012210 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012211 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12212 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12213 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12214 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12215 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12216 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12217 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12218 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012219
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012220verifyhost <hostname>
12221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012222 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12223 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12224 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12225 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12226 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12227 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12228 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12229 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012231weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012232 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12233 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12234 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012235 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12236 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12237 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12238 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12239 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12240 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012241
12242
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122435.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12244-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012245
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012246HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12247using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12248configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012249This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12250can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12251workload.
12252This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12253resolution at run time.
12254Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12255carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12256
12257
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122585.3.1. Global overview
12259----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012260
12261As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12262different steps of the process life:
12263
12264 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12265 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12266 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12267
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012268 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12269 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012270
12271A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12272 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12273 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12274 resolution to know this new IP.
12275
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012276When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012277HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012278SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12279from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12280will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12281will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012282
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012283A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012284 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012285 first valid response.
12286
12287 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12288 servers return an error.
12289
12290
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122915.3.2. The resolvers section
12292----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012293
12294This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012295HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12296contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012297
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012298When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12299uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12300is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12301answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12302
12303When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012304used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012305
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012306 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12307 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12308 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012309
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012310 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12311 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012312
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012313 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12314 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12315 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012316
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012317For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12318following scenarios are possible:
12319
12320 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12321 ignored
12322
12323 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12324 applied
12325
12326 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12327 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12328
12329 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12330 retries the query with a new type
12331
12332 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12333 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012334
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012335As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12336a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012337<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012338
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012339
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012340resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012341 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012342
12343A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12344
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012345accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012346 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012347 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012348 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12349 by RFC 6891)
12350
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012351 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12352
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012353nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12354 DNS server description:
12355 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12356 <ip> : IP address of the server
12357 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12358
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012359parse-resolv-conf
12360 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12361 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12362 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12363
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012364hold <status> <period>
12365 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12366 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012367 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012368 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012369 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12370 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12371 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12372
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012373 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012374
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012375resolve_retries <nb>
12376 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12377 giving up.
12378 Default value: 3
12379
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012380 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12381 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12382 type.
12383
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012384timeout <event> <time>
12385 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12386 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12387 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012388 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12389 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012390 Default value: 1s
12391 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012392 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012393 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012394 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12395 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12396
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012397 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012398
12399 resolvers mydns
12400 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12401 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012402 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012403 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012404 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012405 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012406 hold other 30s
12407 hold refused 30s
12408 hold nx 30s
12409 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012410 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012411 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012412
12413
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200124146. Cache
12415---------
12416
12417HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12418(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12419RAM.
12420
12421The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12422this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12423
12424If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12425independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12426when we try to allocate a new one.
12427
12428The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12429
12430It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12431"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12432for more details.
12433
12434When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12435replaced by "<CACHE>".
12436
12437
124386.1. Limitation
12439----------------
12440
12441The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12442
12443- If the response is not a 200
12444- If the response contains a Vary header
12445- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12446- If the response is not cacheable
12447
12448- If the request is not a GET
12449- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12450- If the request contains an Authorization header
12451
12452
124536.2. Setup
12454-----------
12455
12456To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12457the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12458
12459
124606.2.1. Cache section
12461---------------------
12462
12463cache <name>
12464 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12465 size of cache is mandatory.
12466
12467total-max-size <megabytes>
12468 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12469 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12470
12471max-object-size <bytes>
12472 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12473 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12474 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12475
12476max-age <seconds>
12477 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12478 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12479 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12480 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12481 default.
12482
12483
124846.2.2. Proxy section
12485---------------------
12486
12487http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12488 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12489 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12490 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12491 after this one.
12492
12493http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12494 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12495 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12496 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12497 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12498
12499
12500Example:
12501
12502 backend bck1
12503 mode http
12504
12505 http-request cache-use foobar
12506 http-response cache-store foobar
12507 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12508
12509 cache foobar
12510 total-max-size 4
12511 max-age 240
12512
12513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125147. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12515----------------------------------
12516
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012517HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012518client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12519The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12520these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12521but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12522data called patterns.
12523
12524
125257.1. ACL basics
12526---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012527
12528The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12529content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12530from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12531simple :
12532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012533 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012534 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012535 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12536 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012538The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12539adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012540
12541In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012543 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012544
12545This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12546Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12547and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012548an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12549conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12550as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12551are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012552
12553ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12554'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12555which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12556
12557There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12558performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012560The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12561specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12562this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012563methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12564ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012565
12566Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12567 - boolean
12568 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12569 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12570 - string
12571 - data block
12572
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012573Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12574converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12575would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12576The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12577which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12578
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012579Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12580keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12581fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12582which are summarized in the table below :
12583
12584 +---------------------+-----------------+
12585 | Sample or converter | Default |
12586 | output type | matching method |
12587 +---------------------+-----------------+
12588 | boolean | bool |
12589 +---------------------+-----------------+
12590 | integer | int |
12591 +---------------------+-----------------+
12592 | ip | ip |
12593 +---------------------+-----------------+
12594 | string | str |
12595 +---------------------+-----------------+
12596 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12597 +---------------------+-----------------+
12598
12599Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12600matching method, see below.
12601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012602The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12603 - boolean
12604 - integer or integer range
12605 - IP address / network
12606 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12607 - regular expression
12608 - hex block
12609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012610The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12611
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012612 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12613 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012614 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012615 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012616 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012617 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012618 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012620The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12621read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12622if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12623lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12624will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12625beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12626a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12627lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12628exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12629
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012630The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12631parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12632ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12633a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12634check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12635
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012636The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12637socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12638file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012640Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12641loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12642
12643 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12644
12645In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12646the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12647case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12648as well.
12649
12650The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12651sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12652do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12653methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12654is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012655obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012656followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12657default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12658that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12659string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12660
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012661The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12662By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12663string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12664resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12665server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012666waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012667flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12668function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012670There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12671sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12672be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012673
12674 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12675 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012676 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12677 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12678 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12679 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012680
12681 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12682 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012683 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012684
12685 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012686 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012687
12688 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012689 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012690
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012691 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012692 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12693
12694 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12695 binary or string samples.
12696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012697 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12698 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012700 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12701 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12702 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012704 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12705 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012707 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12708 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012710 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12711 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012713 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12714 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012715 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012717 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12718 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12719 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012720
12721For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12722request, it is possible to do :
12723
12724 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12725
12726In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12727buffer, one would use the following acl :
12728
12729 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12730
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012731On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12732possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12733
12734 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012736All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12737criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12738method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12739to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12740criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12741the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012743If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012744the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12745For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12748 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12749 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12750 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012751
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012752
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012753The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12754types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12755combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12756brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12757default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012759 +-------------------------------------------------+
12760 | Input sample type |
12761 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012762 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012763 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12764 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12765 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012766 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012768 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012769 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012770 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012771 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012772 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012773 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012774 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012775 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012776 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012777 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012778 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012779 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012780 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012781 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012782 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012783 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012784 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012785 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012786 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012787 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12788 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12789 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012790
12791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127927.1.1. Matching booleans
12793------------------------
12794
12795In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12796Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12797When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12798that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12799
12800Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12801return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12802"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128057.1.2. Matching integers
12806------------------------
12807
12808Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12809enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12810to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12811
12812Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12813matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12814lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012815
12816For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12817unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12818representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12819
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012820As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12821two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12822instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12823ranges and operators.
12824
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012825For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012826operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12827Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12828of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012830Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012831
12832 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12833 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12834 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12835 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12836 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12837
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012838For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012839
12840 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12841
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012842This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12843
12844 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128477.1.3. Matching strings
12848-----------------------
12849
12850String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12851different forms :
12852
12853 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012854 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012855
12856 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012857 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858
12859 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12860 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12861
12862 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12863 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12864
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012865 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012866 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12867 matches.
12868
12869 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12870 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12871 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012872
12873String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12874exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12875characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12876string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12877to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012878before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012879
12880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12882---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012883
12884Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12885they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12886possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12887passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12888the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012889the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12890match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012891
12892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128937.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12894-------------------------------------
12895
12896It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12897not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12898a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12899to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12900digits may be used upper or lower case.
12901
12902Example :
12903 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12904 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12905
12906
129077.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12908---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012909
12910IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12911netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12912within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012913host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012914difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12915at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12916does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12917parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012918
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012919The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12920abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12921
12922 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12923 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12924 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12925 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12926 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12927 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12928 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12929 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12930
12931Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12932192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12933
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012934IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12935Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12936trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12937IPv6 patterns.
12938
12939HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12940following situations :
12941 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12942 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12943 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12944 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12945 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12946 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12947 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12948 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12949 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12950 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012952
129537.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12954----------------------------------
12955
12956Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12957combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12958
12959 - AND (implicit)
12960 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12961 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012965 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012967Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12968indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012970For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12971"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12972requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12973is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12974
12975 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012976 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12977 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12978 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012979
12980To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12981and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12982
12983 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12984 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12985 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12986 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12987
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012988 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12990 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12991 use_backend www if host_www
12992
12993It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12994expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12995be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12996the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12997
12998 The following rule :
12999
13000 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013001 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013002
13003 Can also be written that way :
13004
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013005 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006
13007It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13008to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13009simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13010sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13011good use is the following :
13012
13013 With named ACLs :
13014
13015 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13016 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13017 monitor fail if site_dead
13018
13019 With anonymous ACLs :
13020
13021 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13022
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013023See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13024keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013025
13026
130277.3. Fetching samples
13028---------------------
13029
13030Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13031against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13032sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13033ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13034of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13035available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13036
13037This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13038Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13039compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13040deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13041
13042The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13043matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13044method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13045indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13046
13047As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13048when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13049mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13050the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13051ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13052
13053Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13054multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13055when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013056incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13057are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013058is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13059all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13060
13061Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13062 - name
13063 - name(arg1)
13064 - name(arg1,arg2)
13065
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013066
130677.3.1. Converters
13068-----------------
13069
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013070Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13071of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13072is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13073was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013074has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013075unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13076
13077These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13078sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13079the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013080support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013081
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013082A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13083support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13084supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13085(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13086bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013088The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013089
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001309051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13091 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13092 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13093 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13094 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13095 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13096
13097 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013098 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13099 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013100 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13101 frontend http-in
13102 bind *:8081
13103 default_backend servers
13104 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13105 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13106
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013107add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013108 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013109 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013110 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13111 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013112 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013113 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13114 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13115 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13116 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013117 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013118 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013119
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013120aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13121 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13122 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13123 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13124 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13125 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13126 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13127
13128 Example:
13129 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13130 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13131
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013132and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013133 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013134 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013135 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13136 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013137 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013138 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13139 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13140 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13141 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013142 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013143 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013144
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013145b64dec
13146 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13147 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13148
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013149base64
13150 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013151 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013152 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13153
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013154bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013155 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013156 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013157 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013158 presence of a flag).
13159
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013160bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13161 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13162 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013163 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013164
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013165concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13166 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13167 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13168 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13169 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13170 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13171 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13172 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13173 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13174 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13175 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013176 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013177 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013178 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013179
13180 Example:
13181 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13182 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13183 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13184 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13185
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013186cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013187 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13188 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013189
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013190crc32([<avalanche>])
13191 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13192 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13193 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13194 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13195 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13196 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13197 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13198 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13199 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13200 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013201 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13202
13203crc32c([<avalanche>])
13204 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13205 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13206 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13207 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13208 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13209 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13210 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13211 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013212
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013213da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013214 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13215 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13216 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13217 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013218 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013219 configuration language.
13220
13221 Example:
13222 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013223 bind *:8881
13224 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013225 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013226
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013227debug
13228 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13229 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13230 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13231
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013232div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013233 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13234 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013235 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013236 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13237 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013238 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013239 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13240 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13241 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13242 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013243 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013244 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013245
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013246djb2([<avalanche>])
13247 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13248 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13249 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13250 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13251 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13252 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13253 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013254 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13255 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013256
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013257even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013258 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013259 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13260
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013261field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13262 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13263 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13264 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13265 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13266 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13267 fields.
13268
13269 Example :
13270 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13271 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13272 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13273 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13274 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013275
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013276hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013277 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013278 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013279 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013280 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013281
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013282hex2i
13283 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013284 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013285
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013286http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013287 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13288 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013289 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13290 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13291 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13292 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13293 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13294 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13295 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13296 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013297
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013298in_table(<table>)
13299 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13300 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13301 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013302 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013303 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13304
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013305ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13306 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013307 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013308 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13309 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13310 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13311 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13312 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013313
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013314json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013315 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013316 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013317 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013318 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13319 of errors:
13320 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13321 bytes, ...)
13322 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13323 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13324
13325 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13326 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13327 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13328 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13329 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13330 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013331 - "ascii" : never fails;
13332 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13333 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013334 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013335 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013336 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13337 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13338
13339 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013340 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013341
13342 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013343 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013344 capture request header user-agent len 150
13345 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013346
13347 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13348 GET / HTTP/1.0
13349 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13350
13351 Output log:
13352 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13353
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013354language(<value>[,<default>])
13355 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13356 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13357 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13358 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13359 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13360 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13361 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13362 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13363 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013364 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013365 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13366 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013367
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013368 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013369
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013370 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13371 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013372
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013373 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13374 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13375 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13376 use_backend spanish if es
13377 use_backend french if fr
13378 use_backend english if en
13379 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013380
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013381length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013382 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13383 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13384 type. The result is of type integer.
13385
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013386lower
13387 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13388 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13389 type. The result is of type string.
13390
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013391ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13392 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13393 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13394 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13395 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13396 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13397 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13398
13399 Example :
13400
13401 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013402 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013403 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13404
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013405map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13406map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13407map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13408 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13409 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13410 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13411 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13412 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13413 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13414 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13415 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013416
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013417 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13418 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13419 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013420
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013421 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013422 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013423
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013424 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13425 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13426 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13427 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013428 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13429 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013430 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13431 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13432 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13433 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13434 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13435 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13436 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13437 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013438 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13439 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13440 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013441 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13442 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13443 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13444 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13445 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013446
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013447 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13448 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13449 the corresponding match text.
13450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013451 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13452 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13453 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13454 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13455 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013457 Example :
13458
13459 # this is a comment and is ignored
13460 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13461 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13462 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13463 | | | `---------- value
13464 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13465 | `---------------------------- key
13466 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13467
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013468mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013469 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13470 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013471 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013472 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013473 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013474 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13475 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13476 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13477 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013478 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013479 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013480
13481mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013482 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013483 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13484 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013485 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013486 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013487 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013488 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13489 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13490 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13491 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013492 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013493 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013494
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013495nbsrv
13496 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13497 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13498 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13499 map lookup.
13500
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013501neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013502 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13503 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13504 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13505 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013506
13507not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013508 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013509 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013510 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013511 absence of a flag).
13512
13513odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013514 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013515 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13516
13517or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013518 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013519 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013520 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13521 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013522 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013523 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13524 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13525 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13526 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013527 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013528 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013529
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013530protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13531 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13532 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13533 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13534 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13535 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13536 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13537 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13538 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13539 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13540 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13541 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13542
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013543regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013544 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13545 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13546 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13547 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13548 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13549 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13550 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13551 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13552 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13553 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013554 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13555 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13556 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13557 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013558
13559 Example :
13560
13561 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13562 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13563 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13564 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13565
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013566capture-req(<id>)
13567 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13568 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13569
13570 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013571 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13572 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013573
13574capture-res(<id>)
13575 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13576 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13577
13578 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013579 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13580 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013581
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013582sdbm([<avalanche>])
13583 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13584 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13585 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13586 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13587 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13588 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13589 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013590 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13591 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013592
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013593set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013594 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13595 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13596 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013597 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013598 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13599 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013600 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013601 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13602 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013603 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013604 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013605
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013606sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013607 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013608 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13609
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013610sha2([<bits>])
13611 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13612 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13613
13614 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13615 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13616
13617 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13618 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13619
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013620srv_queue
13621 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13622 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13623 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13624 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13625 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13626
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013627strcmp(<var>)
13628 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13629 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13630 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13631 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13632 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13633 shorter).
13634
13635 Example :
13636
13637 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13638 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13639 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13640
13641
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013642sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013643 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13644 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013645 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013646 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13647 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013648 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013649 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13650 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013651 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013652 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13653 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013654 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013655 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013656
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013657table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13658 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13659 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13660 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13661 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13662 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13663 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13664
13665
13666table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13667 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13668 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13669 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13670 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13671 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13672 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13673
13674table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13675 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13676 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013677 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013678 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13679 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13680
13681table_conn_cur(<table>)
13682 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13683 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13684 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13685 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13686 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13687
13688table_conn_rate(<table>)
13689 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13690 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13691 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13692 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13693 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13694
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013695table_gpt0(<table>)
13696 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13697 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13698 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13699 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13700 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13701
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013702table_gpc0(<table>)
13703 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13704 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13705 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13706 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13707 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13708
13709table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13710 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13711 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13712 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13713 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13714 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13715 sample fetch keyword.
13716
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013717table_gpc1(<table>)
13718 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13719 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13720 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13721 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13722 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13723
13724table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13725 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13726 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13727 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13728 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13729 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13730 sample fetch keyword.
13731
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013732table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13733 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13734 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013735 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013736 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13737 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13738
13739table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13740 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13741 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13742 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13743 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13744 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13745 keyword.
13746
13747table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13748 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13749 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013751 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13752 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13753
13754table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13755 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13756 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13757 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13758 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13759 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13760 keyword.
13761
13762table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13763 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13764 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013765 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013766 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13767 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13768 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13769 keyword.
13770
13771table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13772 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13773 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013774 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013775 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13776 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13777 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13778 keyword.
13779
13780table_server_id(<table>)
13781 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13782 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13783 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13784 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13785 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13786 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13787
13788table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13789 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13790 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013791 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013792 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13793 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13794 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13795 keyword.
13796
13797table_sess_rate(<table>)
13798 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13799 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13800 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13801 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13802 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13803 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13804 keyword.
13805
13806table_trackers(<table>)
13807 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13808 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13809 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13810 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13811 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13812 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13813 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13814 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13815 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13816 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13817
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013818upper
13819 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13820 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13821 type. The result is of type string.
13822
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013823url_dec
13824 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13825 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13826
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013827ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013828 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013829 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13830 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13831 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013832 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13833 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13834 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13835 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013836 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013837 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13838 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013839
13840 Example:
13841 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13842 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13843
13844 message Point {
13845 int32 latitude = 1;
13846 int32 longitude = 2;
13847 }
13848
13849 message PPoint {
13850 Point point = 59;
13851 }
13852
13853 message Rectangle {
13854 // One corner of the rectangle.
13855 PPoint lo = 48;
13856 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13857 PPoint hi = 49;
13858 }
13859
13860 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13861 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13862 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13863
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013864 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13865 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013866 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013867 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13868
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013869 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013870
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013871 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013872
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013873 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013874 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13875 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13876
13877 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13878 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13879 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13880
13881 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13882 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13883 interpret the previous binary sample.
13884
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013885
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013886unset-var(<var name>)
13887 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13888 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13889 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13890 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13891 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13892 response),
13893 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13894 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13895 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13896 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13897
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013898utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13899 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13900 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13901 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13902 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13903 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13904 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13905
13906 Example :
13907
13908 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013909 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013910 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13911
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013912word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13913 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13914 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13915 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13916 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13917 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13918
13919 Example :
13920 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13921 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13922 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13923 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13924 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013925
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013926wt6([<avalanche>])
13927 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13928 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13929 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13930 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13931 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13932 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13933 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013934 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13935 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013936
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013937xor(<value>)
13938 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013939 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013940 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013941 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013942 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013943 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13944 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013945 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013946 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13947 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013948 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013949 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013950
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013951xxh32([<seed>])
13952 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13953 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13954 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13955 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13956 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13957 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13958 as cryptographically secure.
13959
13960xxh64([<seed>])
13961 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13962 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13963 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13964 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13965 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13966 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13967 as cryptographically secure.
13968
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013969
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139707.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013971--------------------------------------------
13972
13973A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13974not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13975"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13976The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13977
13978always_false : boolean
13979 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13980 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13981
13982always_true : boolean
13983 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13984 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13985
13986avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013987 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013988 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13989 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13990 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13991 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13992 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13993 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13994 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13995 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13996 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13997 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13998 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13999 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14000 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014002be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014003 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14004 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14005 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14006 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014007 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14008
14009be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14010 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14011 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14012 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14013 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14014 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014015 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14016 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014017
14018 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14019 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14020 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014022be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14023 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14024 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14025 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014026 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014027 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14028 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014029
14030 Example :
14031 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14032 backend dynamic
14033 mode http
14034 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14035 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014036
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014037bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014038 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14039 of the string.
14040
14041bool(<bool>) : bool
14042 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14043 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14046 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014047 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014048 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14049 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014050
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014051 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014052 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014053 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14054
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014055 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14056 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014057
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014058 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014059 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014060 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014061 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014062 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014063 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014064 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014065
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014066 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14067 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014068 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014069 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014070
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014071cpu_calls : integer
14072 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14073 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14074 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14075 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14076 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14077 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14078
14079cpu_ns_avg : integer
14080 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14081 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14082 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14083 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14084 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14085 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14086 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14087 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14088 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14089 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14090 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14091
14092cpu_ns_tot : integer
14093 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14094 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14095 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14096 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14097 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14098 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14099 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14100 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14101 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14102 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14103 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14104 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14105 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14106
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014107date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014108 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014109
14110 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14111 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14112 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014113 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14114
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014115 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14116 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14117 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14118 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14119 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14120
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014121 Example :
14122
14123 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14124 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014125
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014126 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14127 # millisecond granularity
14128 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14129
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014130date_us : integer
14131 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14132 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14133 from the same timeval structure.
14134
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014135distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14136 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14137 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14138 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14139 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14140 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14141 list of supported tokens.
14142
14143distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14144 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14145 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14146 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14147 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14148 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14149 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14150 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14151 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14152 supported tokens.
14153
14154 Example :
14155 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14156 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14157 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14158 # send large files to the big farm
14159 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14160
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014161env(<name>) : string
14162 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14163 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14164 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14165 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14166 certain way.
14167
14168 Examples :
14169 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14170 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14171
14172 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14173 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014175fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14176 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014177 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14178 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014179 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14180 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014181 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014182 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14183 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014184
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014185fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14186 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14187 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14188 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014190fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14191 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14192 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14193 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14194 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14195 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14196 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14197 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14198 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014199
14200 Example :
14201 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14202 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14203 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14204 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14205 frontend mail
14206 bind :25
14207 mode tcp
14208 maxconn 100
14209 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14210 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14211 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14212 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014213
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014214hostname : string
14215 Returns the system hostname.
14216
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014217int(<integer>) : signed integer
14218 Returns a signed integer.
14219
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014220ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14221 Returns an ipv4.
14222
14223ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14224 Returns an ipv6.
14225
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014226lat_ns_avg : integer
14227 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14228 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14229 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14230 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14231 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14232 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14233 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14234 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14235 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14236 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14237 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14238 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14239 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14240 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14241
14242lat_ns_tot : integer
14243 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14244 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14245 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14246 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14247 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14248 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14249 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14250 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14251 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14252 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14253 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14254 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14255 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14256 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14257 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14258 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14259 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14260 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14261 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14262
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014263meth(<method>) : method
14264 Returns a method.
14265
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014266nbproc : integer
14267 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14268 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14269 and debugging purposes.
14270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014271nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14272 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14273 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14274 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014275 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14276 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14277 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014278
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014279prio_class : integer
14280 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14281 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14282 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14283
14284prio_offset : integer
14285 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14286 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14287 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14288 set-priority-offset".
14289
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014290proc : integer
14291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14292 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14293 debugging purposes.
14294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014295queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014296 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14297 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14298 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014299 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14300 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14301 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14302 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14303 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14304
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014305rand([<range>]) : integer
14306 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14307 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14308 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14309 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14310 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14311
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014312uuid([<version>]) : string
14313 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14314 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14315 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014317srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14318 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14319 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14320 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14321 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14322 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014323 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14324 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14325
14326srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14327 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14328 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14329 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14330 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14331 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14332 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14333 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14334
14335 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14336 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014337
14338srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14339 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14340 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14341 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014342 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014343 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14344 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14345 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14346
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014347srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14348 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14349 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14350 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14351 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14352 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14353 fetch methods.
14354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14356 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14357 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014358 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14360 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014361 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014362 overloading servers).
14363
14364 Example :
14365 # Redirect to a separate back
14366 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14367 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14368 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14369
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014370stopping : boolean
14371 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14372 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14373 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14374
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014375str(<string>) : string
14376 Returns a string.
14377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014378table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14379 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14380 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14381
14382table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14383 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14384 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14385 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14386
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014387thread : integer
14388 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14389 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14390 and debugging purposes.
14391
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014392var(<var-name>) : undefined
14393 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014394 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14395 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014396 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014397 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14398 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014399 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014400 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14401 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014402 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014403 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014404
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144057.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406----------------------------------
14407
14408The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14409closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14410methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14411sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14412TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014413the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14414counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014415"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14416used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14417can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14418Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14419table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14420tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14421currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014422
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014423bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014424 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14425 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14426 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428be_id : integer
14429 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14430 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14431
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014432be_name : string
14433 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14434 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014436dst : ip
14437 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14438 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14439 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14440 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014441 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14442 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14443 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14444 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14445 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14446 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447
14448dst_conn : integer
14449 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14450 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14451 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14452 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14453 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14454 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14455 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14456 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014457
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014458dst_is_local : boolean
14459 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14460 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14461 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14462 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014463 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014464 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14465 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14466 it only once per connection.
14467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014468dst_port : integer
14469 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14470 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14471 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14472 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14473 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14474 an HTTP header.
14475
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014476fc_http_major : integer
14477 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14478 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14479 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14480
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014481fc_pp_authority : string
14482 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14483 if any.
14484
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014485fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14486 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14487 header.
14488
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014489fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14490 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14491 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14492 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14493 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14494 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14495 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14496
14497fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14498 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14499 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14500 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14501 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14502 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14503 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14504
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014505fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014506 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14507 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14508 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14509 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14510
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014511fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014512 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14513 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14514 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14515 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14516
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014517fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014518 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14519 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14520 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14521 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14522
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014523fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014524 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14525 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14526 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14527 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14528
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014529fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014530 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14531 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14532 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14533 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14534
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014535fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014536 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14537 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14538 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14539 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14540
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014541fe_defbe : string
14542 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14543 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014545fe_id : integer
14546 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014547 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014548 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14549
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014550fe_name : string
14551 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14552 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14553 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14554
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014555sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014556sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14557sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14558sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014559 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14560 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14561 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14562
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014563sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014564sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14565sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14566sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014567 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14568 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14569 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14570
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014571sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014572sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14573sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14574sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014575 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14576 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014577 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14578 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14579 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014580
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014581 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014582 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14583 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014584 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14585 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14586 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014587 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14588 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14589
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014590sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14591sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14592sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14593sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14594 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14595 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14596 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14597 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14598 when a first ACL was verified.
14599
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014600sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014601sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14602sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14603sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014604 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014605 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14606
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014607sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014608sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14609sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14610sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014611 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14612 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14613 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14614
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014615sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014616sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14617sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14618sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014619 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14620 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14621 See also src_conn_rate.
14622
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014623sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014624sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14625sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14626sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014627 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014628 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014629
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014630sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14631sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14632sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14633sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14634 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14635 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14636
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014637sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14638sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14639sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14640sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14641 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14642 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14643
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014644sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014645sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14646sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14647sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014648 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14649 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14650 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014651 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14652 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14653 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014654
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014655sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14656sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14657sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14658sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14659 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14660 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14661 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14662 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14663 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14664 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14665
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014666sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014667sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14668sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14669sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014670 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014671 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14672 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14673
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014674sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014675sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14676sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14677sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014678 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14679 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14680 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14681 src_http_err_rate.
14682
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014683sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014684sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14685sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14686sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014687 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014688 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14689 src_http_req_cnt.
14690
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014691sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014692sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14693sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14694sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014695 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14696 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14697 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14698 src_http_req_rate.
14699
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014700sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014701sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14702sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14703sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014704 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014705 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14706 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14707 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14708 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014709
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014710 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014711 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14712 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014713 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14714
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014715sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14716sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14717sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14718sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14719 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14720 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14721 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14722 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14723 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14724
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014725sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014726sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14727sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14728sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014729 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14730 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14731 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014732
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014733sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014734sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14735sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14736sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014737 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14738 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14739 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014740
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014741sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014742sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14743sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14744sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014745 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014746 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14747 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14748 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014749 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014750 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14751
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014752sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014753sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14754sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14755sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014756 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14757 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14758 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14759 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14760 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014761 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014762
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014763sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014764sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14765sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14766sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014767 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14768 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14769 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14770
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014771sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014772sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14773sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14774sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014775 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14776 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014777 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014778 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14779 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14781 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14782 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784so_id : integer
14785 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14786 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14787 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014790 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014791 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14792 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14793 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014794 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14795 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14796 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014797 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14798 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14799 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14800 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14801 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14802 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14803 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014804
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014805 Example:
14806 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14807 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014809src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14810 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14811 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14812 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014813 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14816 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14817 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014818 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014819 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014821src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14822 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14823 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14824 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14825 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14826 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14827 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014828
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014829 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014830 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14831 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14832 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14833 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014834 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014835 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14836 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14837
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014838src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14839 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14840 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14841 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14842 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14843 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14844 was verified.
14845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014846src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014847 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014849 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014850 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014852src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014853 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14855 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014856 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14859 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14860 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14861 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014862 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014865 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014867 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014868 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014869
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014870src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14871 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14872 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14873 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14874 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14875
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014876src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14877 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14878 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14879 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14880 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014883 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014885 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14886 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014887 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14888 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14889 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014890
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014891src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14892 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14893 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14894 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14895 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14896 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14897 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14898 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014901 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014903 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014904 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014905 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14908 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14909 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14910 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14911 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014912 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014915 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14917 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014918 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14921 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14922 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14923 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014924 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014925 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14928 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14929 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14930 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014931 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14933 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014934
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014935 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014936 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014937 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014938 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014939
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014940src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14941 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14942 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14943 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14944 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14945 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14946 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14947
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014948src_is_local : boolean
14949 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14950 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14951 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14952 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014953 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014954 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14955 once per connection.
14956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014958 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14959 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14960 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14961 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14962 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014964src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014965 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14966 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14967 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14968 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14969 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014971src_port : integer
14972 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14973 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14974 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14975 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014977src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014978 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014979 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14980 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14981 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014982 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014984src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14985 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14986 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14987 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14988 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014989 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014991src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14992 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14993 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14994 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14995 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14996 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14997 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14998 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14999 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015000
15001 Example :
15002 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15003 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15004 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15005 listen ssh
15006 bind :22
15007 mode tcp
15008 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015009 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015010 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015011 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013srv_id : integer
15014 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15015 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15016 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015017
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015018srv_name : string
15019 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15020 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15021 debugging.
15022
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150237.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015024----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15027closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15028when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15029usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015030future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015031
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001503251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15033 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15034 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15035 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15036 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15037 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15038
15039 Example :
15040 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15041 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15042 # the request.
15043 frontend http-in
15044 bind *:8081
15045 default_backend servers
15046 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15047 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15048
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015049ssl_bc : boolean
15050 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15051 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15052 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15053
15054ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15055 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15056 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15057
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015058ssl_bc_alpn : string
15059 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15060 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015061 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015062 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15063 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15064 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15065 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15066 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15067 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15068
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015069ssl_bc_cipher : string
15070 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15071 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15072
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015073ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15074 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15075 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15076 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15077
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015078ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15079 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15080 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15081 session or a TLS ticket.
15082
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015083ssl_bc_npn : string
15084 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15085 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015086 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015087 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15088 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15089 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15090 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15091 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15092
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015093ssl_bc_protocol : string
15094 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15095 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15096
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015097ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015098 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015099 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15100 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015101
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015102ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15103 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15104 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15105 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15106
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015107ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15108 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15109 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15110 if session was reused or not.
15111
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015112ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15113 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15114 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15115 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15116 BoringSSL.
15117
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015118ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15119 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15120 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015122ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15123 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15124 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15125 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15126 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15127 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015129ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15130 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15131 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15132 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15133 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015134
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015135ssl_c_der : binary
15136 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15137 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15138 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140ssl_c_err : integer
15141 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15142 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15143 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15144 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15145 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015147ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15148 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15149 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15150 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15151 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15152 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15153 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15154 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15155 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015157ssl_c_key_alg : string
15158 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15159 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15160 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162ssl_c_notafter : string
15163 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15164 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15165 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015167ssl_c_notbefore : string
15168 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15169 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15170 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015172ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15173 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15174 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15175 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15176 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15177 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15178 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15179 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15180 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182ssl_c_serial : binary
15183 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15184 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15185 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15188 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15189 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15190 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015191 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15192 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15193
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015194 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015195 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15198 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15199 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15200 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202ssl_c_used : boolean
15203 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15204 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015206ssl_c_verify : integer
15207 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15208 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15209 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15210 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212ssl_c_version : integer
15213 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15214 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015215
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015216ssl_f_der : binary
15217 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15218 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15219 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15222 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15223 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15224 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15225 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015226 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015227 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15228 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15229 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231ssl_f_key_alg : string
15232 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15233 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15234 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236ssl_f_notafter : string
15237 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15238 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15239 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015241ssl_f_notbefore : string
15242 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15243 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15244 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15247 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15248 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15249 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15250 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15251 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15252 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15253 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15254 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015256ssl_f_serial : binary
15257 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15258 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15259 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015260
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015261ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15262 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15263 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15264 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15267 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15268 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15269 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015271ssl_f_version : integer
15272 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15273 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15274
15275ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015276 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15277 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15278 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280 Example :
15281 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15282 listen http-https
15283 bind :80
15284 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15285 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15286
15287ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15288 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15289 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15290
15291ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015292 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015293 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15294 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15295 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15296 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15297 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15298 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15299 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15300 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015302ssl_fc_cipher : string
15303 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15304 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015305
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015306ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15307 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15308 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015309 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015310
15311ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15312 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15313 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015314 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015315
15316ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15317 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15318 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15319 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015320 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015321 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015322
15323ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15324 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15325 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015326 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015327
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015328ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15329 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15330 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15331 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015333ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015334 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15335 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015336 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15337 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15338 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15339 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015340
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015341ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15342 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15343 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15344 wait until the handshake happened.
15345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015346ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15347 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015348 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15349 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015350 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015351 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015352
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015353ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015354 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015355 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15356 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015359 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015360 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15361 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15362 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15363 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15364 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15365 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15366 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368ssl_fc_protocol : string
15369 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15370 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015371
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015372ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015373 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015374 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15375 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015376
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015377ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15378 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15379 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15380 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15383 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15384 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15385 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15386 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015387
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015388ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15389 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15390 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15391 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15392 BoringSSL.
15393
15394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015395ssl_fc_sni : string
15396 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15397 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15398 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15399 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15400 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15401
15402 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15403 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15404 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015405 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015406 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015408 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15410 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15413 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15414 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015415
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015416
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154177.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015418------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015420Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15421sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15422only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15423For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15424be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15425can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15426sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15427for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15428content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015430payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015431 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15433 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015435payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15436 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015437 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015438 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015439
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015440req.hdrs : string
15441 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15442 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15443 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15444 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15445
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015446req.hdrs_bin : binary
15447 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15448 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15449 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15450 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15451 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15452 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15453
15454 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15455
15456 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15457 str: <int:length><bytes>
15458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459req.len : integer
15460req_len : integer (deprecated)
15461 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15462 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15463 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15464 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15465 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15466 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15467 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15468 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015470req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15471 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015472 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15473 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15474 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15475 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477 ACL alternatives :
15478 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15481 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15482 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15483 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15484 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 ACL alternatives :
15487 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491req.proto_http : boolean
15492req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15493 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15494 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15495 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15496 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15497 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15498 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15499 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501 Example:
15502 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15503 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15504 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015505 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15508rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15509 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15510 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15511 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15512 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15513 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15514 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15515 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15518 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15519 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15520 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15521 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15522 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015524 ACL derivatives :
15525 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527 Example :
15528 listen tse-farm
15529 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15530 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15531 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15532 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15533 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15534 persist rdp-cookie
15535 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15536 # This is only useful makes sense if
15537 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15538 stick-table type string size 204800
15539 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15540 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15541 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15544 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15547rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15548 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15549 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15550 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15551 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553 ACL derivatives :
15554 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015555
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015556req.ssl_alpn : string
15557 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15558 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15559 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15560 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15561 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15562 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015563 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015564
15565 Examples :
15566 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15567 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15568 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015569 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015570 default_backend bk_default
15571
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015572req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15573 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15574 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015575 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15576 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15577 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15578 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15579 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15582req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15583 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15584 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15585 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15586 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15587 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15588 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15589 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591req.ssl_sni : string
15592req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15593 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15594 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15595 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15596 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15597 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15598 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15599 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15600 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15601 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15602 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15603 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15604 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606 ACL derivatives :
15607 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609 Examples :
15610 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15611 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15612 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15613 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15614 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015615
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015616req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15617 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15618 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15619 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15620 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15621 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15622 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15623 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15624 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15625 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015627req.ssl_ver : integer
15628req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15629 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15630 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15631 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15632 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15633 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15634 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15635 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015636 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639 ACL derivatives :
15640 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015641
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015642res.len : integer
15643 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15644 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15645 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15646 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15647 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15648 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15649 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15650 content inspection.
15651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15653 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015654 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15655 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15656 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15657 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15660 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15661 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15662 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15663 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015666
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015667res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15668rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15669 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15670 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15671 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15672 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15673 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15674 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15675 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677wait_end : boolean
15678 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15679 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015680 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15682 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015683 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015684 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15685 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687 Examples :
15688 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15689 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15690 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15693 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15694 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15695 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15696 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15697 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15698 tcp-request content reject
15699
15700
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157017.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702--------------------------------------
15703
15704It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15705This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15706data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15707its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15708HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15709content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15710to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15711more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15712response are indexed.
15713
15714base : string
15715 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15716 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15717 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15718 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15719 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15720 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15721 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15722 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15723
15724 ACL derivatives :
15725 base : exact string match
15726 base_beg : prefix match
15727 base_dir : subdir match
15728 base_dom : domain match
15729 base_end : suffix match
15730 base_len : length match
15731 base_reg : regex match
15732 base_sub : substring match
15733
15734base32 : integer
15735 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15736 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15737 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015738 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15739 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15740 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741
15742base32+src : binary
15743 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15744 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15745 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15746 per-URL counters.
15747
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015748capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15749 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15750 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15751 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15752
15753capture.req.method : string
15754 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15755 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15756 because it's allocated.
15757
15758capture.req.uri : string
15759 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15760 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15761 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15762 allocated.
15763
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015764capture.req.ver : string
15765 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15766 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15767 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15768
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015769capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15770 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15771 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15772 The first entry is an index of 0.
15773 See also: "capture response header"
15774
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015775capture.res.ver : string
15776 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15777 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15778 persistent flag.
15779
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015780req.body : binary
15781 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15782 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15783 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15784 the first chunk is analyzed.
15785
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015786req.body_param([<name>) : string
15787 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15788 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15789 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15790 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15791 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15792 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15793 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15794 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15795 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15796 given.
15797
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015798req.body_len : integer
15799 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15800 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15801 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15802 "option http-buffer-request".
15803
15804req.body_size : integer
15805 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15806 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15807 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15808 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15809 "option http-buffer-request".
15810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015811req.cook([<name>]) : string
15812cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15813 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15814 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15815 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15816 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15817 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15818 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15819 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15820 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15821
15822 ACL derivatives :
15823 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15824 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15825 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15826 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15827 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15828 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15829 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15830 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015832req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15833cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15834 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15835 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15838cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15839 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15840 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15841 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15842 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15845 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15846 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15847 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15848 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015849 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15851 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15852 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15853 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15856 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15857 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15858 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15859 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015860 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15863 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15864 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15865 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15866 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15867 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15868 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15869 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15870 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15873 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15874 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15875 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15876 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15879 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15880 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15881 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15882 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15883 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15884 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15885 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15886 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015887 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015889 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891 ACL derivatives :
15892 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15893 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15894 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15895 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15896 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15897 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15898 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15899 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15900
15901req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15902hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15903 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15904 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15905 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15906 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15907 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15908 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15909 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15910 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15911 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15912
15913req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15914hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15915 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15916 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15917 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15918 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15919 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015920 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15922 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15923
15924req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15925hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15926 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15927 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15928 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15929 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15930 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15931 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15932 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15933
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015934
15935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15937 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15938 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15939 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15940 basic auth is supported.
15941
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015942http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15943 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15944 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15945 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15946 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15948 basic auth is supported.
15949
15950 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015951 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15952 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15953 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15954 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020015956http_auth_pass : string
15957 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
15958 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15959 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15960
15961http_auth_type : string
15962 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
15963 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15964 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15965
15966http_auth_user : string
15967 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
15968 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
15969 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015971http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015972 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15973 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15975 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977method : integer + string
15978 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15979 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15980 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15981 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15982 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15983 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15984 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986 ACL derivatives :
15987 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989 Example :
15990 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15991 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15992 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015994path : string
15995 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15996 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15997 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15998 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15999 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016000 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016001 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003 ACL derivatives :
16004 path : exact string match
16005 path_beg : prefix match
16006 path_dir : subdir match
16007 path_dom : domain match
16008 path_end : suffix match
16009 path_len : length match
16010 path_reg : regex match
16011 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016012
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016013query : string
16014 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16015 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16016 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16017 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016018 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016019 which stops before the question mark.
16020
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016021req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16022 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16023 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16024 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16025 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027req.ver : string
16028req_ver : string (deprecated)
16029 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16030 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16031 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016033 ACL derivatives :
16034 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036res.comp : boolean
16037 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16038 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16039 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041res.comp_algo : string
16042 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16043 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16044 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046res.cook([<name>]) : string
16047scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16048 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16049 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16050 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016052 ACL derivatives :
16053 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016055res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16056scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16057 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16058 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16059 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16062scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16063 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16064 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16065 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16068 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16069 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16070 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16071 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16072 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16073 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16074 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16075 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16076 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16079 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16080 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16081 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16082 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16083 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16086shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16087 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16088 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16089 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16090 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16091 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16092 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16093 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16094 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096 ACL derivatives :
16097 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16098 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16099 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16100 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16101 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16102 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16103 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16104 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16105
16106res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16107shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16108 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16109 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16110 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16111 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16112 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16115shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16116 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16117 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16118 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16119 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16120 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16121 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016122
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016123res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16124 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16125 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16126 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16127 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16130shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16131 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16132 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16133 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16134 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16135 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16136 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138res.ver : string
16139resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16140 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16141 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016143 ACL derivatives :
16144 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16147 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16148 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016149 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016150 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16153 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155status : integer
16156 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16157 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16158 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016159
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016160unique-id : string
16161 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16162 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16163 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16164 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16165 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16166 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168url : string
16169 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16170 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16171 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16172 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16173 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16174 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16175 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177 ACL derivatives :
16178 url : exact string match
16179 url_beg : prefix match
16180 url_dir : subdir match
16181 url_dom : domain match
16182 url_end : suffix match
16183 url_len : length match
16184 url_reg : regex match
16185 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016187url_ip : ip
16188 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16189 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16190 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16191 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16192 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16193 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16194 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016196url_port : integer
16197 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16198 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16199 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16200 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016201
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016202urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16203url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016204 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16205 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016206 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16207 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16208 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16209 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16211 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016212 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16213 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215 ACL derivatives :
16216 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16217 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16218 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16219 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16220 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16221 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16222 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16223 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016224
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226 Example :
16227 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16228 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16229 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16230 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016231
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016232urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016233 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16234 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16235 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016236
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016237url32 : integer
16238 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16239 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16240 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16241 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16242 is an unsigned integer.
16243
16244url32+src : binary
16245 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16246 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16247 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16248
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162507.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016251---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016253Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16254every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016255order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016257ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16258---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016259FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016260HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016261HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16262HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016263HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16264HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16265HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16266HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16267LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016268METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016269METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016270METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16271METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16272METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16273METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016274METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016275METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016276RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016277REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016278TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016279WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16280---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016281
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162838. Logging
16284----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016285
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016286One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16287provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16288very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16289provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16290state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016291to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016292headers.
16293
16294In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16295about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16296send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16297
16298 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16299 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16300 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16301 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16302 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016303 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016304 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016305
16306The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16307allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16308as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16309while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16310real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16311delay.
16312
16313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163148.1. Log levels
16315---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016316
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016317TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016318source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016319HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16320in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16321track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16322syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16323about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016324
16325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163268.2. Log formats
16327----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016328
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016329HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016330and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16331slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16332options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016333
16334 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16335 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16336 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16337 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16338 extents.
16339
16340 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16341 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16342 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16343 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16344 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16345
16346 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16347 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16348 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16349 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16350 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16351
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016352 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16353 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16354 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16355 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16356
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016357 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16358
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016359Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16360specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16361field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16362servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16363always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16364identifier.
16365
16366Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16367 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16368 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16369 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16370 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16371
16372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163738.2.1. Default log format
16374-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016375
16376This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16377as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16378format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16379
16380 Example :
16381 listen www
16382 mode http
16383 log global
16384 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16385
16386 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16387 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16388 (www/HTTP)
16389
16390 Field Format Extract from the example above
16391 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16392 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16393 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16394 4 'to' to
16395 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16396 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16397
16398Detailed fields description :
16399 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16400 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16401 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16402 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16403 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16404 and processed the connection.
16405 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16406
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016407In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16408"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16409connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16410
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016411It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16412will eventually disappear.
16413
16414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164158.2.2. TCP log format
16416---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016417
16418The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16419is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16420information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16421counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16422emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16423environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16424the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16425sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016426specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16427not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16428fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16429marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016430
16431 Example :
16432 frontend fnt
16433 mode tcp
16434 option tcplog
16435 log global
16436 default_backend bck
16437
16438 backend bck
16439 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16440
16441 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16442 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16443 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16444
16445 Field Format Extract from the example above
16446 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16447 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16448 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16449 4 frontend_name fnt
16450 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16451 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16452 7 bytes_read* 212
16453 8 termination_state --
16454 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16455 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16456
16457Detailed fields description :
16458 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016459 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16460 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16461 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016462 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016463 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016464 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016465
16466 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016467 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16468 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16469 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016470
16471 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16472 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16473 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016474 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16475 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16476 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16477 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016478
16479 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16480 and processed the connection.
16481
16482 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16483 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16484 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16485 applications.
16486
16487 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16488 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16489 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16490 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16491 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16492
16493 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16494 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16495 See "Timers" below for more details.
16496
16497 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16498 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16499 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16500 "Timers" below for more details.
16501
16502 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016503 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016504 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16505 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16506 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16507 details.
16508
16509 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16510 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16511 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16512 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16513 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16514
16515 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16516 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16517 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16518 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16519 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16520 for more details.
16521
16522 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016523 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016524 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16525 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16526 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016527 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016528
16529 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16530 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16531 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16532 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16533 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16534 caused by a denial of service attack.
16535
16536 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16537 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16538 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16539 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16540 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16541 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16542 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16543 denial of service attack.
16544
16545 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16546 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16547 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16548 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16549 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16550 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16551 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16552 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16553 be processed than on other servers.
16554
16555 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16556 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16557 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16558 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16559 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16560 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16561 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16562 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16563 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16564 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16565 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16566 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16567 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16568
16569 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16570 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16571 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16572 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16573 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16574 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016575 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016576 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16577
16578 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16579 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16580 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16581 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16582 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16583 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016584 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016585 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16586 occurs.
16587
16588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165898.2.3. HTTP log format
16590----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016591
16592The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16593is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16594the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16595are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16596emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16597generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16598"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16599which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016600frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16601is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016602
16603Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16604slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16605with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16606
16607 Example :
16608 frontend http-in
16609 mode http
16610 option httplog
16611 log global
16612 default_backend bck
16613
16614 backend static
16615 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16616
16617 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16618 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16619 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016620 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016621
16622 Field Format Extract from the example above
16623 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16624 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016625 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016626 4 frontend_name http-in
16627 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016628 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016629 7 status_code 200
16630 8 bytes_read* 2750
16631 9 captured_request_cookie -
16632 10 captured_response_cookie -
16633 11 termination_state ----
16634 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16635 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16636 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16637 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16638 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016639
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016640Detailed fields description :
16641 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016642 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16643 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16644 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016645 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016646 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016647 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016648
16649 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016650 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16651 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16652 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016653
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016654 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16655 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016656
16657 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16658 and processed the connection.
16659
16660 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16661 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16662 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16663
16664 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16665 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16666 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16667 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16668 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16669 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16670
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016671 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16672 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16673 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016674 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016675 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16676 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016677 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16678 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016679
16680 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16681 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016682 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016683
16684 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16685 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016686 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16687 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016688
16689 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16690 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16691 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16692 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16693 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016694 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16695 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016696
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016697 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16698 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16699 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16700 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16701 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16702 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16703 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016704 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016705
16706 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16707 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16708 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16709
16710 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16711 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016712 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16714 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16715 overflowing.
16716
16717 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16718 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16719 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16720 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16721 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16722 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16723 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16724 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16725
16726 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16727 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16728 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16729 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16730 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16731 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16732 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16733 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16734
16735 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16736 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16737 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16738 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16739 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16740 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16741 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16742
16743 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016744 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016745 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16746 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16747 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016748 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016749 system.
16750
16751 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16752 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16753 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16754 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16755 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16756 caused by a denial of service attack.
16757
16758 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16759 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16760 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16761 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16762 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16763 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16764 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16765 denial of service attack.
16766
16767 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16768 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16769 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16770 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16771 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16772 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16773 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16774 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16775 processed than on other servers.
16776
16777 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16778 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16779 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16780 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16781 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16782 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16783 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16784 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16785 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16786 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16787 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16788 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16789 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16790
16791 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16792 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16793 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16794 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16795 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16796 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016797 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016798 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16799
16800 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16801 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16802 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16803 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16804 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16805 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016806 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016807 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16808 occurs.
16809
16810 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16811 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16812 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16813 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16814 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16815 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16816 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16817 cookies" below for more details.
16818
16819 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16820 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16821 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16822 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16823 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16824 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16825 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16826 and cookies" below for more details.
16827
16828 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16829 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16830 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16831 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16832 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16833 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16834 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16835 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16836
16837
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168388.2.4. Custom log format
16839------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016840
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016841The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016842mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016843
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016844HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016845Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16846separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16847prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16848
16849Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16850variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016851("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016852
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016853If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016854as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016855less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16856the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16857
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016858Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016859In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016860in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016861
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016862Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16863'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16864https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16865such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16866
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016867Flags are :
16868 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016869 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016870 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16871 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016872
16873 Example:
16874
16875 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16876 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16877
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016878 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16879
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016880At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16881
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016882 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16883 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016884
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016885the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016886
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016887 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16888 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16889 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016890
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016891and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16892
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016893 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16894 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016895
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016896Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16897
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016898 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016899 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016900 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16901 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16902 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016903 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16904 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16905 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016906 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016907 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16908 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016909 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016910 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16911 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016912 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016913 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016914 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016915 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016916 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016917 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016918 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016919 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16920 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16921 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16922 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16923 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016924 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016925 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16926 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016927 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016928 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16929 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016930 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16931 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16932 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016933 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016934 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16935 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016936 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016937 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16938 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16939 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016940 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016941 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016942 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16943 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16944 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16945 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016946 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016947 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016948 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016949 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016950 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016951 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016952 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16953 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16954 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016955 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016956 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16957 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016958 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016959 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16960 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016961 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016962 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016963 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016964 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016965
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016966 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016967
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016968
169698.2.5. Error log format
16970-----------------------
16971
16972When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16973protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16974By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16975"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016976will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016977logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16978
16979The format looks like this :
16980
16981 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16982 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16983 Connection error during SSL handshake
16984
16985 Field Format Extract from the example above
16986 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16987 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16988 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16989 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16990 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16991
16992These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16993failures.
16994
16995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169968.3. Advanced logging options
16997-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016998
16999Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17000just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17001options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17002for more information about their usage.
17003
17004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17006------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017007
17008It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17009haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17010commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17011monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17012ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17013
17014 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17015 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17016 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17017 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17018
17019 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17020 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17021 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017022 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017023 such as other load-balancers.
17024
17025 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17026 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17027 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17028
17029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170308.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17031----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017032
17033The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17034what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17035or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017036"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017037just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17038log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17039after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17040is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17041with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17042with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17043
17044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170458.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17046------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017047
17048Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17049for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17050"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17051retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17052raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17053a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17054file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17055you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17056"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17057
17058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170598.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17060--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017061
17062Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17063multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17064them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17065"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17066logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17067error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17068and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17069too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17070useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17071alternative.
17072
17073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170748.4. Timing events
17075------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017076
17077Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17078reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17079the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17080frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017081mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17082addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17083
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017084Timings events in HTTP mode:
17085
17086 first request 2nd request
17087 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17088 t tr t tr ...
17089 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17090 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17091 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17092 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17093 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17094
17095Timings events in TCP mode:
17096
17097 TCP session
17098 |<----------------->|
17099 t t
17100 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17101 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17102 |<------ Tt ------->|
17103
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017104 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017105 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017106 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17107 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17108 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017109 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017110 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17111 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17112 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17113 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017114
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017115 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17116 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17117 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017118 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17119 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17120 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17121 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17122 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17123 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017124
17125 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17126 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17127 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17128 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17129 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17130 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17131 request typed by hand during a test.
17132
17133 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17134 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017135 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017136 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17137 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17138 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17139 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017140
17141 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17142 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17143 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17144 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17145 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17146
17147 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17148 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17149 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17150 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17151 connection never established.
17152
17153 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17154 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17155 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17156 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17157 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17158 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17159 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17160 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17161 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17162 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17163 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17164
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017165 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17166 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17167 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17168 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17169 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17170 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17171
17172 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17173
17174 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17175 "Ta" can never be negative.
17176
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017177 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17178 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017179 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17180 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017181 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017182
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017183 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017184
17185 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017186 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17187 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017188
17189These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17190protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17191that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017192due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17193"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17194that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017195
17196Most common cases :
17197
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017198 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17199 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17200 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17201 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17202 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17203 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17204 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17205 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17206 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17207 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17208 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017209 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017210
17211 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17212 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17213 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17214 of ms on remote networks.
17215
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017216 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17217 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17218 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017219
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017220 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17221 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17222 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17223 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17224 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17225 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17226 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17227 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17228 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017229
17230Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17231
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017232 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017233 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017234 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017235
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017236 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017237 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17238 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17239
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017240 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017241 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17242 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17243 flags.
17244
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017245 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17246 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017247 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17248 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17249 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17250 the client connection was maintained open.
17251
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017252 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017253 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017254 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017255 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17256
17257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172588.5. Session state at disconnection
17259-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017260
17261TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17262"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172632-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17264each of which has a special meaning :
17265
17266 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17267 session to terminate :
17268
17269 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17270
17271 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17272 server explicitly refused it.
17273
17274 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17275 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17276 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17277 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017278 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017279
17280 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17281 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017282
17283 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17284 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17285 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17286 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17287 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17288
17289 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17290 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17291 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17292 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17293 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17294
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017295 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17296 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17297
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017298 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17299 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17300 backup connections when going up.
17301
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017302 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17303
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017304 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17305 send or receive data.
17306
17307 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17308 send or receive data.
17309
17310 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17311 with nothing left in the buffers.
17312
17313 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17314
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017315 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017316 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17317
17318 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17319 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17320 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17321 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17322 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17323
17324 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17325 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17326
17327 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17328 server (HTTP only).
17329
17330 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17331
17332 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17333 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17334 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17335
17336 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17337 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17338 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17339
17340 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17341
17342 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17343 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17344
17345 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17346 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17347 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17348
17349 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17350 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017351 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17352 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017353
17354 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17355 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17356 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17357 another server.
17358
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017359 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017360 server.
17361
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017362 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17363 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17364 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17365 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17366
17367 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17368 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17369 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17370 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17371
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017372 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17373 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17374 "use-server" rule).
17375
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017376 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17377
17378 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17379 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17380
17381 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17382
17383 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17384 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17385 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17386
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017387 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17388 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017389 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017390 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17391 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17392
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017393 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17394
17395 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17396 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17397
17398 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17399
17400 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17401
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017402The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17403was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017404helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17405starvation, attacks, etc...
17406
17407The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17408alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17409easier finding and understanding.
17410
17411 Flags Reason
17412
17413 -- Normal termination.
17414
17415 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17416 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17417 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17418 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17419
17420 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17421 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17422 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17423 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17424 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17425 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017426
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017427 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17428 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017429 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017430
17431 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17432 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17433 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17434
17435 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17436 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17437 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17438 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17439 the server takes too long to respond.
17440
17441 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17442 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17443 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17444 long a time to respond.
17445
17446 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17447 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17448 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17449 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017450 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17451 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017452
17453 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17454 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17455 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17456 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17457 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017458 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017459 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17460 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17461 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17462 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17463 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17464 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17465 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17466 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017467 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017468 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17469 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17470 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017471
17472 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17473 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017474 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17475 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17476 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17477 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017478
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017479 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17480 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017482 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17484 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017485 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017486 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17487 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17488
17489 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17490 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17491 503 or 504 here.
17492
17493 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17494 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17495 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17496 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17497 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17498
17499 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17500 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017501 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017502 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17503 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17504
17505 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17506 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17507 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17508 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17509 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17510 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17511 between haproxy and the server.
17512
17513 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17514 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17515 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17516 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17517 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17518 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17519 solution is to fix the application.
17520
17521 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17522 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17523 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17524 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17525 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17526 external attacks.
17527
17528 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17529 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017530 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017531 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17532 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17533
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017534 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17535 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17536 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017537 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017538 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017539
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017540 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17541 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17542 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17543 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017544 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17545 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17546 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17547 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17548 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017549
17550 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17551 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17552 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17553 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17554
17555 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17556 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17557 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17558 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17559
17560 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17561 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17562 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17563 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17564
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017565The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17566persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17567important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17568re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17569
17570 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17571
17572 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17573 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17574 set on a GET request.
17575
17576 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17577 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017578 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017579 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17580
17581 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17582 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17583 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17584
17585 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17586 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17587 already got a cookie.
17588
17589 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17590 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17591 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17592 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17593 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17594
17595 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17596 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17597 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17598
17599 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17600 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17601 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17602
17603 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17604 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17605
17606 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17607 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17608 then advertised in the response.
17609
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176118.6. Non-printable characters
17612-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017613
17614In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17615consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17616converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17617prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17618being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17619escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17620is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17621'}' when logging headers.
17622
17623Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17624issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17625containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17626
17627Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17628the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17629performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17630
17631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176328.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17633---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017634
17635Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17636achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017637section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017638cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17639the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17640the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017641locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017642not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17643user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17644a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17645wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17646
17647 Examples :
17648 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17649 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17650
17651 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17652 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17653
17654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176558.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17656---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017657
17658Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17659proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17660the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17661server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17662
17663Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17664response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017665section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017666
17667It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017668time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17669appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017670are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17671and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17672follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17673request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17674in the logs.
17675
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017676As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17677frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17678an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17679
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017680 Example :
17681 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17682 listen proxy-out
17683 mode http
17684 option httplog
17685 option logasap
17686 log global
17687 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17688
17689 # log the name of the virtual server
17690 capture request header Host len 20
17691
17692 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17693 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17694
17695 # log the beginning of the referrer
17696 capture request header Referer len 20
17697
17698 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17699 capture response header Server len 20
17700
17701 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17702 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17703
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017704 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017705 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17706
17707 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17708 capture response header Via len 20
17709
17710 # log the URL location during a redirection
17711 capture response header Location len 20
17712
17713 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17714 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17715 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17716 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17717 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17718
17719 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17720 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17721 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17722 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017723 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017724
17725 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17726 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17727 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17728 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17729 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017730 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017731
17732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177338.9. Examples of logs
17734---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017735
17736These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17737them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17738reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17739
17740 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17741 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17742 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17743
17744 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17745 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17746
17747 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17748 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17749 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17750
17751 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17752 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17753
17754 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17755 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17756 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17757
17758 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017759 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017760 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17761 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17762
17763 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17764 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17765 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17766
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017767 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17768 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17769 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17770 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17771 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17772 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017773
17774 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017775 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017776
17777 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17778 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17779 Nothing was sent to any server.
17780
17781 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17782 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17783
17784 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17785 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017786 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017787 send a 408 return code to the client.
17788
17789 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17790 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17791
17792 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17793 5 seconds ("c----").
17794
17795 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17796 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017797 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017798
17799 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017800 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017801 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17802 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17803 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17804 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17805 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017806
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017807
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178089. Supported filters
17809--------------------
17810
17811Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17812accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17813unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17814
17815See also : "filter"
17816
178179.1. Trace
17818----------
17819
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017820filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017821
17822 Arguments:
17823 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17824 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17825
17826 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17827 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17828 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17829 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17830
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017831 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017832 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17833 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17834 amount of the parsed data.
17835
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017836 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017837
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017838This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17839callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17840information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17841filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17842
17843Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17844tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17845a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17846
17847
178489.2. HTTP compression
17849---------------------
17850
17851filter compression
17852
17853The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17854keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017855when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
17856fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
17857done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
17858explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
17859filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
17860listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17861order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017862
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017863See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
17864 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017865
17866
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178679.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17868--------------------------------------------
17869
17870filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17871
17872 Arguments :
17873
17874 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17875 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17876 parsed.
17877
17878 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17879 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17880 part must be placed in its own scope.
17881
17882The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17883external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017884streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017885exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17886also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17887
17888SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17889the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17890
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017891For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017892"doc/SPOE.txt".
17893
17894Important note:
17895 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17896 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17897
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100178989.4. Cache
17899----------
17900
17901filter cache <name>
17902
17903 Arguments :
17904
17905 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17906
17907The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17908"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017909cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017910other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
17911case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
17912is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17913filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017914listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17915order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017916
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017917See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
17918 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
17919
17920
179219.5. Fcgi-app
17922-------------
17923
17924filter fcg-app <name>
17925
17926 Arguments :
17927
17928 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
17929
17930The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
17931request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
17932reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
17933used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
17934implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
17935used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
17936fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
17937used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17938order.
17939
17940See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
17941 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
17942
17943
1794410. FastCGI applications
17945-------------------------
17946
17947HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
17948feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
17949the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
17950FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
17951servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
17952FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
17953backend.
17954
17955HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
17956application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
17957connection.
17958
1795910.1. Setup
17960-----------
17961
1796210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
17963--------------------------
17964
17965fcgi-app <name>
17966 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
17967 document root must be defined.
17968
17969acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
17970 Declare or complete an access list.
17971
17972 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
17973 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
17974 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
17975 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
17976 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
17977
17978docroot <path>
17979 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
17980 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
17981 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
17982
17983index <script-name>
17984 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
17985 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
17986 is an optional setting.
17987
17988 Example :
17989 index index.php
17990
17991log-stderr global
17992log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
17993 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
17994 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
17995
17996 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
17997 default STDERR messages are ignored.
17998
17999pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18000 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18001 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18002 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18003
18004 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18005 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18006 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18007 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18008
18009 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18010 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18011
18012path-info <regex>
18013 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18014 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18015 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18016 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18017 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18018
18019 Example :
18020 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18021
18022option get-values
18023no option get-values
18024 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18025
18026 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18027 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18028
18029 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18030 application will accept.
18031
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018032 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18033 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018034
18035 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18036 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18037 option is disabled.
18038
18039 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18040 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18041 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18042 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18043 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18044 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18045
18046option keep-conn
18047no option keep-conn
18048 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18049 sending a response.
18050
18051 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18052 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18053
18054option max-reqs <reqs>
18055 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18056 accept.
18057
18058 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18059 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18060 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18061 to 1.
18062
18063option mpxs-conns
18064no option mpxs-conns
18065 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18066
18067 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18068 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18069
18070set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18071 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18072 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18073 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18074 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18075
18076 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18077 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18078 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18079
18080 Example :
18081 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18082 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18083
18084 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18085
18086
1808710.1.2. Proxy section
18088---------------------
18089
18090use-fcgi-app <name>
18091 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18092
18093 Arguments :
18094 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18095
18096 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18097 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18098 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18099 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18100 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18101
18102 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18103 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18104 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18105 application are evaluated.
18106
18107
1810810.1.3. Example
18109---------------
18110
18111 frontend front-http
18112 mode http
18113 bind *:80
18114 bind *:
18115
18116 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18117 default_backend back-static
18118
18119 backend back-static
18120 mode http
18121 server www A.B.C.D:80
18122
18123 backend back-dynamic
18124 mode http
18125 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18126 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18127
18128 fcgi-app php-fpm
18129 log-stderr global
18130 option keep-conn
18131
18132 docroot /var/www/my-app
18133 index index.php
18134 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18135
18136
1813710.2. Default parameters
18138------------------------
18139
18140A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18141the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18142scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18143applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18144
18145 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18146 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18147 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18148 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18149 | | |
18150 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18151 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18152 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18153 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18154 | | application. |
18155 | | |
18156 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18157 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18158 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18159 | | |
18160 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18161 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18162 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18163 | | the application's configuration. |
18164 | | |
18165 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18166 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18167 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18168 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18169 | | |
18170 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18171 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18172 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18173 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18174 | | be defined. |
18175 | | |
18176 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18177 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18178 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18179 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18180 | | is not set too. |
18181 | | |
18182 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18183 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18184 | | set. |
18185 | | |
18186 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18187 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18188 | | the request. |
18189 | | |
18190 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18191 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18192 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18193 | | |
18194 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18195 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18196 | | script to process the request. |
18197 | | |
18198 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18199 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18200 | | |
18201 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18202 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18203 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18204 | | |
18205 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18206 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18207 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18208 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18209 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18210 | | |
18211 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18212 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18213 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18214 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18215 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18216 | | side. |
18217 | | |
18218 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18219 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18220 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18221 | | connected to. |
18222 | | |
18223 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18224 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18225 | | |
18226 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18227 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18228 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18229 | | |
18230 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18231
18232
1823310.3. Limitations
18234------------------
18235
18236The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18237way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18238during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18239establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18240application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18241or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18242message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18243these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18244and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18245
18246Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18247request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18248requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18249
18250About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18251into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18252fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18253"http-request" ones.
18254
18255Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18256FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18257processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18258must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18259here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018261/*
18262 * Local variables:
18263 * fill-column: 79
18264 * End:
18265 */